blob: 19235150bde674520815f79778df74d1fd5cdc91 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01005 version 1.5.11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01007 2015/02/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
Willy Tarreau34d05b02015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001151disabled
1152 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1153 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1154 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1155
1156enable
1157 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1158
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001159peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1160 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1161 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1162 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1163 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1164 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1165 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1166
1167 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1168 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1169
1170 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1171 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1172 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1173 across all peers.
1174
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001175 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1176 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1177 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1178
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001179 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001180 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001181 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1182 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1183 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001184
1185 backend mybackend
1186 mode tcp
1187 balance roundrobin
1188 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1189 stick on src
1190
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001191 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1192 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001193
1194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011954. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001196----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001197
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001198Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1199 - defaults <name>
1200 - frontend <name>
1201 - backend <name>
1202 - listen <name>
1203
1204A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1205its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1206section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
1209A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1210connections.
1211
1212A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1213to forward incoming connections.
1214
1215A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1216parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1219'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1220case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1221
1222Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1223logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1224proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1225However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1226name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1227
1228Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1229and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001230bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001231protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1232modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1233arbitrary criteria.
1234
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001235In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1236a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1237the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1238
1239 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1240 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1241 between responses and new requests.
1242
1243 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1244 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1245 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1246 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1247
1248 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1249 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1250 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1251
1252 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1253 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1254 client-facing connection remains open.
1255
1256 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1257 after the end of the response.
1258
1259The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1260frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1261following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1262weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1263
1264 Backend mode
1265
1266 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1269 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1270 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1271 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1272 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1273 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1274 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1275 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1276 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1281--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001283The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1284limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1285they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1286limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001287marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001288option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001289and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1290with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1291specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001294 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1295------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1296acl - X X X
1297appsession - - X X
1298backlog X X X -
1299balance X - X X
1300bind - X X -
1301bind-process X X X X
1302block - X X X
1303capture cookie - X X -
1304capture request header - X X -
1305capture response header - X X -
1306clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001307compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1309cookie X - X X
1310default-server X - X X
1311default_backend X X X -
1312description - X X X
1313disabled X X X X
1314dispatch - - X X
1315enabled X X X X
1316errorfile X X X X
1317errorloc X X X X
1318errorloc302 X X X X
1319-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1320errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001321force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001322fullconn X - X X
1323grace X X X X
1324hash-type X - X X
1325http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001326http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001327http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001329http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001330http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001331id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001332ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001333log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001334log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001335max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001336maxconn X X X -
1337mode X X X X
1338monitor fail - X X -
1339monitor-net X X X -
1340monitor-uri X X X -
1341option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1342option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1343option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1344option allbackups (*) X - X X
1345option checkcache (*) X - X X
1346option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1347option contstats (*) X X X -
1348option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1349option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1350option forceclose (*) X X X X
1351-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1352option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001353option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001354option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001355option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001357option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001358option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1359option httpchk X - X X
1360option httpclose (*) X X X X
1361option httplog X X X X
1362option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001363option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001364option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001365option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1366option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1367option logasap (*) X X X -
1368option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001369option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001370option nolinger (*) X X X X
1371option originalto X X X X
1372option persist (*) X - X X
1373option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001374option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375option smtpchk X - X X
1376option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1377option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1378option splice-request (*) X X X X
1379option splice-response (*) X X X X
1380option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1381option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1382-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001383option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001384option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1385option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1386option tcpka X X X X
1387option tcplog X X X X
1388option transparent (*) X - X X
1389persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1390rate-limit sessions X X X -
1391redirect - X X X
1392redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1393redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1394reqadd - X X X
1395reqallow - X X X
1396reqdel - X X X
1397reqdeny - X X X
1398reqiallow - X X X
1399reqidel - X X X
1400reqideny - X X X
1401reqipass - X X X
1402reqirep - X X X
1403reqisetbe - X X X
1404reqitarpit - X X X
1405reqpass - X X X
1406reqrep - X X X
1407-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1408reqsetbe - X X X
1409reqtarpit - X X X
1410retries X - X X
1411rspadd - X X X
1412rspdel - X X X
1413rspdeny - X X X
1414rspidel - X X X
1415rspideny - X X X
1416rspirep - X X X
1417rsprep - X X X
1418server - - X X
1419source X - X X
1420srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001421stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001422stats auth X - X X
1423stats enable X - X X
1424stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001425stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001426stats realm X - X X
1427stats refresh X - X X
1428stats scope X - X X
1429stats show-desc X - X X
1430stats show-legends X - X X
1431stats show-node X - X X
1432stats uri X - X X
1433-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1434stick match - - X X
1435stick on - - X X
1436stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001437stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001438stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001439tcp-check connect - - X X
1440tcp-check expect - - X X
1441tcp-check send - - X X
1442tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001443tcp-request connection - X X -
1444tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001445tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001446tcp-response content - - X X
1447tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448timeout check X - X X
1449timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1452timeout connect X - X X
1453timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1454timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1455timeout http-request X X X X
1456timeout queue X - X X
1457timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001458timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1460timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001461timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001463unique-id-format X X X -
1464unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001465use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001466use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001467------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1468 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1472---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1475
1476
1477acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1478 Declare or complete an access list.
1479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1480 no | yes | yes | yes
1481 Example:
1482 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1483 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1484 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001486 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
1488
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001489appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1490 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | no | yes | yes
1494 Arguments :
1495 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1496 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1497
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001498 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001499 checked in each cookie value.
1500
1501 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1502 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1503 milliseconds.
1504
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001505 request-learn
1506 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1507 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1508 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1509 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1510 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1511 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1512
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001513 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1514 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1515 data following this prefix.
1516
1517 Example :
1518 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1519
1520 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1521 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1522
1523 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1524 2 modes are currently supported :
1525 - path-parameters :
1526 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1527 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1528 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1529 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1530 - query-string :
1531 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1532 query string.
1533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1535 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1536 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1537 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001538 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1539 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1540 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1542 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1543
1544 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1545
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001546 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1547 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1548 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1549
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550 Example :
1551 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1552
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001553 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1554 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555
1556
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557backlog <conns>
1558 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1560 yes | yes | yes | no
1561 Arguments :
1562 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1563 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001564 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001565
1566 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1567 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1568 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1569 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1570 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1571 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1572 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1573 backlog parameter.
1574
1575 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1576 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1577 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1578
1579 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1580
1581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001582balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001583balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1586 yes | no | yes | yes
1587 Arguments :
1588 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1589 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1590 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1591 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1592
1593 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1594 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1595 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1596 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001597 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001598 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001599 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1600 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1601 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1602 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1603 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1604 it, so that you don't worry.
1605
1606 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1607 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1608 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1609 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1610 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1611 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1612 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1613 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001615 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1616 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1617 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1618 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1619 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1620 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1621 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1622 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1623
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001624 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001625 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1627 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001628 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001629 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1630 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1631 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1632 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1633 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001634 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1635 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1636 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1637 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1638 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1639 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1642 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1643 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1644 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1645 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1646 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1647 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1648 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001649 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001651 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1652 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1653 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001654
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001655 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1656 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1657 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1658 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1659 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1660 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1661 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1662 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1663 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1664 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1665 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1666 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001667
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001668 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001669 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1670 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1671 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1672 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1673 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1674 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1675 URIs start with a leading "/".
1676
1677 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1678 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1679 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1680 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001683 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1684
1685 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001686 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1687 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001688 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1689 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1690 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1691 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001692 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001693 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1694 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001695
1696 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1697 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1698 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1699 server will receive the request.
1700
1701 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1702 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1703 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1704 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1705 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001706 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1707 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1708 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001710 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1711 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1712 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1713 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1714 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001717 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1718 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1719 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1720
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001721 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1722 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1723 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1724
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001725 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001726 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001727 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1728 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1729 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1730 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1731 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1732 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001734 used instead.
1735
1736 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1737 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1738 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1739 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1740
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001741 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1742 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1743 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1744
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001745 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001748 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1749 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001751 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1752 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1753 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754
1755 Examples :
1756 balance roundrobin
1757 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001758 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001759 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1760 balance hdr(host)
1761 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001762
1763 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1764 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001767 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1768 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1769 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1770 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1771
1772 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1773 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1774 defaults to 16 kB.
1775
1776 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1777 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1778
1779 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1780 Round Robin.
1781
1782 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1783 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1784 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1785 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1786
1787 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1788
1789 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001790 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001791 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1792 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1793 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001795 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1796 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
1798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001799bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1800bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1803 no | yes | yes | no
1804 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001805 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1806 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1807 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1808 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001809 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001810 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1811 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1812 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1813 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1814 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1815 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1816 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001817 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1818 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1819 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1820 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1821 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1822 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1823 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001824 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1825 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1826 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001827 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1828 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1829 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1830 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001831
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001832 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1833 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1835 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1836 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001837 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1838 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1839 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1840 the range.
1841
1842 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1843 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1844 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1845 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1846 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1847 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1848 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001849 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001850 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001852 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1853 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1854 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1855 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1856 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1857 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1858 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1859 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001861 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1862 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1863 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1864 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1867 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1868 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1869 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1870 in a frontend.
1871
1872 Example :
1873 listen http_proxy
1874 bind :80,:443
1875 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001877
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001878 listen http_https_proxy
1879 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001880 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001881
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001882 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1883 bind ipv6@:80
1884 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1885 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1886
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001887 listen external_bind_app1
1888 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1889
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001890 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001891 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1897 yes | yes | yes | yes
1898 Arguments :
1899 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1900 may be used to override a default value.
1901
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001902 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001903 option may be combined with other numbers.
1904
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001905 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001906 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1907 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1908 missing from all processes.
1909
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001910 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001911 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001912 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1913 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1914 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1915 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001916
1917 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1918 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1919 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1920 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1921 and 'even' instances.
1922
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001923 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1924 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1925 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1926 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001928 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1929 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1930
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001931 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1932 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1933 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1934
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001935 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1936 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1937
1938 Example :
1939 listen app_ip1
1940 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
1943 listen app_ip2
1944 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001945 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001946
1947 listen management
1948 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001949 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001950
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001951 listen management
1952 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1953 bind-process 1-4
1954
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001955 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001956
1957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958block { if | unless } <condition>
1959 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | yes
1962
1963 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1964 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001965 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001966 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001967 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1968 "block" statements per instance.
1969
1970 Example:
1971 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1972 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1973 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1974 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001976 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977
1978
1979capture cookie <name> len <length>
1980 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1982 no | yes | yes | no
1983 Arguments :
1984 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1985 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1986 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1987 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1988 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1989
1990 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1991 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1992 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1993 right if it exceeds <length>.
1994
1995 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1996 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1997 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1998 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1999
2000 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2001 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2002 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2003
2004 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2005 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2006 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002007 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2008 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2009 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010
2011 Example:
2012 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2013
2014 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002015 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
2017
2018capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002019 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2021 no | yes | yes | no
2022 Arguments :
2023 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002024 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2026 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2027 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2028
2029 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2030 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2031 it exceeds <length>.
2032
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002033 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2035 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002036 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2037 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2038 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2039 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002040 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002041 environments to find where the request came from.
2042
2043 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2044 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2045 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2046 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002048 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2049 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2050 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2051 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2052 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
2054 Example:
2055 capture request header Host len 15
2056 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2057 capture request header Referrer len 15
2058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002059 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060 about logging.
2061
2062
2063capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002064 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2066 no | yes | yes | no
2067 Arguments :
2068 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002069 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2071 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2072 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2073
2074 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2075 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2076 it exceeds <length>.
2077
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002078 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2080 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2081 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002082 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2083 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2084 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2085 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002087 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2088 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2089 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2090 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2091 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
2093 Example:
2094 capture response header Content-length len 9
2095 capture response header Location len 15
2096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002097 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098 about logging.
2099
2100
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002101clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2104 yes | yes | yes | no
2105 Arguments :
2106 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2107 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2108 as explained at the top of this document.
2109
2110 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2111 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2112 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2113 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2114 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2115 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2116 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2117 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002118 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2120 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2121
2122 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2123 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2124 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2125 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2126 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2127 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2128
2129 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2130 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2131
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2133 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002135compression algo <algorithm> ...
2136compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002137compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002138 Enable HTTP compression.
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | yes
2141 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002142 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2143 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2144 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2145
2146 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002147 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002148 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2149 data.
2150
2151 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2152 support for zlib was built in.
2153
2154 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2155 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2156 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2157 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2158 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2159 in.
2160
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002161 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002162 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002163 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2164 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2165 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2166 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2167 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002168
2169 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2170 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2171 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2172 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2173 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002174 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2175 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2176 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2177 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2178 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002179 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2180 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002181
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002182 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002183 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2184 "Accept-Encoding" header
2185 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002186 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002187 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2188 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002189 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2190 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2191 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2192 "multipart"
2193 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2194 header
2195 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2196 and later
2197 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2198 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002199
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002200 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2201 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002202
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002203 Examples :
2204 compression algo gzip
2205 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002207contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002208 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 yes | no | yes | yes
2211 Arguments :
2212 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2214 as explained at the top of this document.
2215
2216 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002217 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002218 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2220 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2221 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2222 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2223
2224 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2225 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2226 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2227 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2228 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2229 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2230
2231 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2232 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2233 instead.
2234
2235 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2236 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2237
2238
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002239cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002240 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2241 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2244 yes | no | yes | yes
2245 Arguments :
2246 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2247 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2248 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2249 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2250 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2251 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2252 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2253 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2254 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2255
2256 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2257 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2258 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2259 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2260 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2261 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2262 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2263 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2264 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2265 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2266 "insert" and "prefix".
2267
2268 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002269 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002270
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002271 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002272 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2273 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2274 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2275 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2276 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2277 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2278 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2279 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2280 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2281 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
2283 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2284 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2285 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2286 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2287 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2288 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2289 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2290 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2291 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2292 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002293 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2294 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2295 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002297 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2298 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2299 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002300 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2301 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2302 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2303 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002304 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2305 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2306 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2309 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2310 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2311 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2312 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2313 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2314 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2315 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2316 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2317
2318 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2319 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2320 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2321 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2322 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2323 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2324 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2325 persistence cookie in the cache.
2326 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2327
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002328 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2329 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2330 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2331 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2332 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2333 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2334 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2335 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2336 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2337 they logout.
2338
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002339 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2340 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2341 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2342 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2343
2344 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2345 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2346 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2347 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2348 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2349 this attribute.
2350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002352 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002353 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2354 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2355 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2356 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2357 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2358 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002359
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002360 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2361 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2362 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2363 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2364 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2365 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2366 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2367 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2368 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2369 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2370 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2371 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2372 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2373 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2374 the site.
2375
2376 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2377 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2378 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2379 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2380 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2381 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2382 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2383 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2384 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2385 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2386 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2387 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2388 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2389 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2390 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2391 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2394 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2395 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2396 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398 Examples :
2399 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2400 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2401 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002402 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002404 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002405 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002408default-server [param*]
2409 Change default options for a server in a backend
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2411 yes | no | yes | yes
2412 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002413 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2414 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2415 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2416 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002417
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002418 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002419 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2420
2421 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424default_backend <backend>
2425 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 yes | yes | yes | no
2428 Arguments :
2429 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2430
2431 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2432 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2433 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2434 will catch all undetermined requests.
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436 Example :
2437
2438 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2439 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2440 default_backend dynamic
2441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002442 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002445description <string>
2446 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2448 no | yes | yes | yes
2449 Arguments : string
2450
2451 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2452 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2453 it describes.
2454 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2455
2456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457disabled
2458 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2460 yes | yes | yes | yes
2461 Arguments : none
2462
2463 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2464 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2465 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2466 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2467 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2468 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2469 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2470
2471 See also : "enabled"
2472
2473
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002474dispatch <address>:<port>
2475 Set a default server address
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002478 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002479
2480 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2481 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2482 during start-up.
2483
2484 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2485 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2486 possible with normal servers.
2487
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002488 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002489 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2490 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2491 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2492 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2493
2494 See also : "server"
2495
2496
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497enabled
2498 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2500 yes | yes | yes | yes
2501 Arguments : none
2502
2503 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2504 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2505
2506 See also : "disabled"
2507
2508
2509errorfile <code> <file>
2510 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | yes
2513 Arguments :
2514 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002515 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
2517 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002518 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002520 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2521 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
2523 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2524 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2525 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2526
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002527 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2530 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2531 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2532 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2533
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002534 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2535 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2536 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2537 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2538 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2539 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002541 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2542 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2543 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002544 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2546
2547 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2548
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002549 Example :
2550 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002551 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002552 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2553 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2554
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002555
2556errorloc <code> <url>
2557errorloc302 <code> <url>
2558 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 yes | yes | yes | yes
2561 Arguments :
2562 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002563 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002564
2565 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2566 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2567 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2568 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2569 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2570
2571 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2572 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2573 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2574
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002575 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2578 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2579 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2580 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2581 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2582 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2583 request.
2584
2585 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2586
2587
2588errorloc303 <code> <url>
2589 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2591 yes | yes | yes | yes
2592 Arguments :
2593 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2594 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2595
2596 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2597 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2598 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2599 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2600 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2601
2602 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2603 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2604 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2605
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002606 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2609 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2610 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2611 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002612 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613
2614 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2615
2616
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002617force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2618 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 no | yes | yes | yes
2621
2622 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2623 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2624 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2625 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2626 marked down for maintenance operations.
2627
2628 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2629 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2630 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2631 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2632 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2633 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2634 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2635 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2636 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2637
2638 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2639 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2640 is used.
2641
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002642 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002643 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002644
2645
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646fullconn <conns>
2647 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | no | yes | yes
2650 Arguments :
2651 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2652 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2653
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002654 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002656 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002657 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2658 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2659 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2660 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2661 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002662 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002664 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2665 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002666 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2667 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2668 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002670 Example :
2671 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2672 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2673 # connections.
2674 backend dynamic
2675 fullconn 10000
2676 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2677 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2678
2679 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2680
2681
2682grace <time>
2683 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002685 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 Arguments :
2687 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2688 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2689 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2690
2691 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2692 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002693 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002694 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2695
2696 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2697 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2698 simplify it.
2699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002701hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002702 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2704 yes | no | yes | yes
2705 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002706 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2707 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002708
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002709 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2710 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2711 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2712 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2713 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2714 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2715 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2716 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2717 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2718 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002719
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002720 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2721 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2722 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2723 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2724 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2725 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2726 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2727 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2728 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2729 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2730 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2731 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2732 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002733 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2734 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002735
2736 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2737
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002738 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002739 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2740 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2741 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002742 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2743 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2744 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002745
2746 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2747 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002748 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2749 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2750 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2751 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2752
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002753 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2754 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2755 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2756 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2757 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2758 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2759 parameter.
2760
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002761 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2762
2763 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2764 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2765 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2766 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2767 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2768 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2769 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2770 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2771 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2772 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2773 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2774 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002775
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002776 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2777 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2778 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002779
2780 See also : "balance", "server"
2781
2782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783http-check disable-on-404
2784 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002786 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 Arguments : none
2788
2789 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2790 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2791 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2792 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2793 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2794 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2795 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2796 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002797 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2798 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2799 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2800
2801 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2802
2803
2804http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002805 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002808 Arguments :
2809 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2810 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002811 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002812 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2813 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2814 details on the supported keywords.
2815
2816 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2817 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2818 with the usual backslash ('\').
2819
2820 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2821 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2822 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2823 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2824 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2825
2826 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002827 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002828 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2829 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2830 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2831
2832 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002834 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2835 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2836 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2837 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2838
2839 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002840 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002841 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2842 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2843 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2844 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2845 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2846 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2847 trace).
2848
2849 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002851 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2852 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2853 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2854 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2855 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2856 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2857
2858 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2859 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2860 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2861 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2862 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2863 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2864 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2865 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2866
Cyril Bontéa448e162015-01-30 00:07:07 +01002867 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
2868 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
2869 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
2870
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002871 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2872 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2873
2874 Examples :
2875 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002876 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002877
2878 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002879 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002880
2881 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002882 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002883
2884 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002885 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002887 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002888
2889
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002890http-check send-state
2891 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2893 yes | no | yes | yes
2894 Arguments : none
2895
2896 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2897 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2898 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2899 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2900 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2901
2902 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2903 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2904 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2905 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2906 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2907 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2908 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2909 checked in multiple backends.
2910
2911 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2912 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2913
2914 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2915 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2916 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2917 one fails.
2918
2919 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2920 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2921 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2922
2923 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2924 server's queue.
2925
2926 Example of a header received by the application server :
2927 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2928 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2929
2930 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2931
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002932http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002933 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002934 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002935 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2936 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002937 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2938 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2939 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2940 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2941 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2942 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002944 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2945
2946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2947 no | yes | yes | yes
2948
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002949 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2950 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2951 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2952 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2953 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002954
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002955 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2956 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2957 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2958
2959 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2960 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2961 are evaluated.
2962
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002963 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2964 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2965 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2966 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2967 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2968 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2969 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2970 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2971 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002972 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002973 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2974
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002975 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2976 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2977 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2978 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2979 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2980
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002981 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2982 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2983 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002984 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2985 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002986
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002987 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2988 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2989 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2990 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2991 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2992 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2993 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2994 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2995
2996 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2997 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2998 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01002999 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3000 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003001
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003002 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3003 <name>.
3004
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003005 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3006 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3007 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3008 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3009 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3010 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3011 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3012 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3013
3014 Example:
3015
3016 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3017
3018 applied to:
3019
3020 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3021
3022 outputs:
3023
3024 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3025
3026 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3027
3028 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3029 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3030 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3031 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3032 header.
3033
3034 Example:
3035
3036 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3037
3038 applied to:
3039
3040 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3041
3042 outputs:
3043
3044 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3045
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003046 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3047 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3048 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3049 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3050 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3051 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3052 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3053 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3054
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003055 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3056 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3057 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3058 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3059 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3060 another equipment.
3061
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003062 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3063 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3064 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3065 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3066 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3067 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3068 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3069 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3070
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003071 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3072 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3073 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3074 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3075 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3076 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3077 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3078 admin privileges.
3079
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003080 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3081 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3082 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3083 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3084 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3085 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3086 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3087 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3088
3089 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3090 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3091 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3092 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3093 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3094 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3095
3096 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3097 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3098 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3099 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3100 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3101 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3102
3103 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3104 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3105 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3106 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3107 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3108 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3109 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3110 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3111 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3112
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003113 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3114
3115 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3116 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3117 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3118 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003119
3120 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003121 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3122 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3123 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003124
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003125 http-request allow if nagios
3126 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3127 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3128 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003129
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003130 Example:
3131 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003132 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003133
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003134 Example:
3135 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3136 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3137 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3138 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3140 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3141 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3142 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3143 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3144
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003145 Example:
3146 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3147 acl add path /addacl
3148 acl del path /delacl
3149
3150 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3151
3152 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3153 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3154
3155 Example:
3156 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3157 acl setmap path /setmap
3158 acl delmap path /delmap
3159
3160 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3161
3162 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3163 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3164
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003165 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3166 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003167
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003168http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003169 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003170 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3171 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003172 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3173 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3174 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3175 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3176 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3177 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003178 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003179 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3180
3181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3182 no | yes | yes | yes
3183
3184 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3185 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3186 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3187 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3188 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3189 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3190
3191 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3192 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3193 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3194 current section.
3195
3196 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3197 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3198 rules are evaluated.
3199
3200 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3201 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3202 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3203 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3204 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3205 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3206 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3207
3208 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3209 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3210 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3211 external users.
3212
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003213 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3214 <name>.
3215
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003216 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3217 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3218 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3219 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3220 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3221 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3222 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3223 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3224
3225 Example:
3226
3227 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3228
3229 applied to:
3230
3231 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3232
3233 outputs:
3234
3235 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3236
3237 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3238
3239 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3240 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3241 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3242 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3243 header.
3244
3245 Example:
3246
3247 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3248
3249 applied to:
3250
3251 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3252
3253 outputs:
3254
3255 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3256
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003257 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3258 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3259 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3260 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3261 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3262 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3263 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3264 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3265
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003266 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3267 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3268 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3269 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3270 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3271 another equipment.
3272
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003273 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3274 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3275 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3276 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3277 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3278 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3279 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3280 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3281
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003282 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3283 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3284 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3285 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3286 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3287 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3288 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3289 admin privileges.
3290
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003291 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3292 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3293 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3294 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3295 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3296 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3297 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3298 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3299
3300 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3301 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3302 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3303 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3304 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3305 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3306
3307 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3308 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3309 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3310 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3311 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3312 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3313
3314 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3315 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3316 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3317 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3318 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3319 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3320 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3321 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3322 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3323
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003324 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3325
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003326 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003327 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3328 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3329 rules.
3330
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003331 Example:
3332 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3333
3334 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3335
3336 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3337 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3338
3339 Example:
3340 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3341
3342 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3343
3344 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3345 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3346
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003347 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3348 ACL usage.
3349
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003350
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003351http-send-name-header [<header>]
3352 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3353
3354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3355 yes | no | yes | yes
3356
3357 Arguments :
3358
3359 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3360
3361 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3362 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3363 is added with the header string proved.
3364
3365 See also : "server"
3366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003367id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003368 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3370 no | yes | yes | yes
3371 Arguments : none
3372
3373 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3374 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3375 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003376
3377
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003378ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3379 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 no | yes | yes | yes
3382
3383 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3384 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3385 and running).
3386
3387 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3388 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3389 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003390 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003391 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3392
3393 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3394 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3395
3396 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3397 "unless" condition is met.
3398
3399 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3400
3401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003402log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003403log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003404no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003405 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3407 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003408
3409 Prefix :
3410 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3411 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3412 prefix does not allow arguments.
3413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003414 Arguments :
3415 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3416 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3417 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3418 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3419 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3420 parameter.
3421
3422 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3423 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3424
3425 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3426 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3427 standard syslog port).
3428
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003429 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3430 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3431 standard syslog port).
3432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003433 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3434 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3435 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3436 appropriately writeable).
3437
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003438 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3439 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3440 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3441 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3442
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003443 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3444 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3445 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3446 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3447 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3448 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3449 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3450 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3451 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3452 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3453 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3454
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3456
3457 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3458 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3459 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3460
3461 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3462 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3463 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003464 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3465 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3466 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3467 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3468 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003469
3470 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3471
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003472 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3473 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3474 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003475
3476 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3477 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3478 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3479 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3480
3481 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3482 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483
3484 Example :
3485 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003486 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3487 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003488 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003491log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003492 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003495
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003496 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3497 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3498 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3499 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3500 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003501
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003502
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003503max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3504 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | no | yes | yes
3507
3508 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3509 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3510 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3511 servers.
3512
3513 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3514 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3515 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3516 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3517 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3518 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3519 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3520 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3521 picking a different server.
3522
3523 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3524 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3525 even if they have to be queued.
3526
3527 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3528 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3529
3530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531maxconn <conns>
3532 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 yes | yes | yes | no
3535 Arguments :
3536 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3537 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3538 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3539 closes.
3540
3541 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3542 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3543 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3544 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3545 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3546 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3547 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3548 properly tuned.
3549
3550 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3551 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3552 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3553
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003554 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3555
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003556 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3557
3558
3559mode { tcp|http|health }
3560 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3562 yes | yes | yes | yes
3563 Arguments :
3564 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3565 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3566 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3567 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3568
3569 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3570 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3571 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3572 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3573 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3574
3575 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003576 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3577 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3578 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3579 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3580 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3581 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3582 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003584 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3585 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3586 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003588 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003589 defaults http_instances
3590 mode http
3591
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003592 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003595monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003596 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3598 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003599 Arguments :
3600 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3601 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003602 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003603 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3604 backend and its backup.
3605
3606 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3607 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3608 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3609 servers in a list of backends.
3610
3611 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3612 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3613 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3614 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3615 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3616 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3617 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003618 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3619 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620
3621 Example:
3622 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003623 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003624 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3625 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3626 monitor-uri /site_alive
3627 monitor fail if site_dead
3628
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003629 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003630
3631
3632monitor-net <source>
3633 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | yes | yes | no
3636 Arguments :
3637 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3638 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3639 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3640 followed by a mask.
3641
3642 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3643 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003644 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003645 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3646
3647 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3648 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3649 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3650 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003651 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3652 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3653 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003655 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3656 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3657 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3658 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3659 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3660 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003661
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003662 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3663 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003664
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003665 Example :
3666 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3667 frontend www
3668 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3669
3670 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3671
3672
3673monitor-uri <uri>
3674 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 yes | yes | yes | no
3677 Arguments :
3678 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3679 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3680
3681 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3682 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3683 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3684 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3685 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3686 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3687 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3688 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3689
3690 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3691 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3692 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3693 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3694 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3695 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3696
3697 Example :
3698 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3699 frontend www
3700 mode http
3701 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3702
3703 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003705
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003706option abortonclose
3707no option abortonclose
3708 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | no | yes | yes
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3714 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3715 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3716 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003717 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003718 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3719 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3720 encountered while delivering the response.
3721
3722 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3723 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3724 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3725 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3726 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3727 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003728 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003729 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003730 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003731 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3732 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3733 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3734
3735 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3736 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3737 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3738 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3739 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3740 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3741 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3742 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003743 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003744
3745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3747
3748 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3749
3750
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003751option accept-invalid-http-request
3752no option accept-invalid-http-request
3753 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3755 yes | yes | yes | no
3756 Arguments : none
3757
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003758 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003759 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3760 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3761 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3762 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3763 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3764 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3765 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003766 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3767 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3768 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3769 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3770 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003771 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
3772 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple
3773 digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003774
3775 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3776 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3777 been confirmed.
3778
3779 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3780 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003781 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3782 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003783 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3784
3785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3787
3788 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3789 stats socket.
3790
3791
3792option accept-invalid-http-response
3793no option accept-invalid-http-response
3794 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | no | yes | yes
3797 Arguments : none
3798
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003799 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003800 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3801 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3802 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3803 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3804 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3805 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3806 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003807 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
3808 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
3809 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003810
3811 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3812 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3813 been confirmed.
3814
3815 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3816 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3817 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3818 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3819
3820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3822
3823 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3824 stats socket.
3825
3826
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003827option allbackups
3828no option allbackups
3829 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | no | yes | yes
3832 Arguments : none
3833
3834 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3835 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3836 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3837 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3838 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3839 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3840 order between the backup servers anymore.
3841
3842 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3843 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3844
3845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3847
3848
3849option checkcache
3850no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003851 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | no | yes | yes
3854 Arguments : none
3855
3856 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3857 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003858 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003859 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3860 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003861 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003862
3863 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003864 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003865 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003866 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3867 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003868 to the client are :
3869 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003870 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003871 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003872 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3873 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3874 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3875 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3876 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3877 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3878 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3879 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3880 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3881 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3882 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3883
3884 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003885 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003886 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003887 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003888 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3889
3890 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3891 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003892 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003893 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3894
3895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3897
3898
3899option clitcpka
3900no option clitcpka
3901 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | yes | yes | no
3904 Arguments : none
3905
3906 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3907 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3908 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3909 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3910
3911 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3912 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3913 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3914 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3915
3916 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3917 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3918 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3919 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3920 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3921
3922 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3923
3924 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3925 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3926 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3927
3928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3930
3931 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3932
3933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934option contstats
3935 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3937 yes | yes | yes | no
3938 Arguments : none
3939
3940 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3941 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3942 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3943 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3944 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3945 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3946 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3947
3948
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003949option dontlog-normal
3950no option dontlog-normal
3951 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 yes | yes | yes | no
3954 Arguments : none
3955
3956 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3957 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3958 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3959 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3960 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3961 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3962 logged.
3963
3964 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3965 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3966 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003968 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003969 logging.
3970
3971
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003972option dontlognull
3973no option dontlognull
3974 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 yes | yes | yes | no
3977 Arguments : none
3978
3979 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3980 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3981 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3982 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3983 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3984 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003985 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
3986 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
3987 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003988
3989 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3990 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3991 would not be logged.
3992
3993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3995
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003996 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
3997 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003998
3999
4000option forceclose
4001no option forceclose
4002 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004004 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004005 Arguments : none
4006
4007 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4008 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4009 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4010 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4011 global session times in the logs.
4012
4013 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004014 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004015 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004016
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004017 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4018 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4019 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4020
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004021 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4022 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004023
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4026
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004027 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004028
4029
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004030option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004031 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | yes | yes | yes
4034 Arguments :
4035 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4036 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004037 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004038 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004039
4040 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4041 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4042 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4043 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4044 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4045 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4046 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004047 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4048 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4049 possible that the client has already brought one.
4050
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004051 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004052 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004053 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4054 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004055 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4056 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004057
4058 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4059 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4060 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4061 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4062 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4063 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4064 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4065
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004066 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4067 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4068 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4069 are under the control of the end-user.
4070
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004071 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004072 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4073 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004074 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4075 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4076 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004077
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004078 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004079 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4080 frontend www
4081 mode http
4082 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4083
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004084 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4085 backend www
4086 mode http
4087 option forwardfor header X-Client
4088
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004089 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004090 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004091
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004092
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004093option http-ignore-probes
4094no option http-ignore-probes
4095 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | yes | yes | no
4098 Arguments : none
4099
4100 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4101 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4102 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4103 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4104 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4105 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4106 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4107 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4108 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4109 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4110 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4111 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4112
4113 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4114 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4115 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4116 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4117 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4118 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4119 are often the only way to detect them.
4120
4121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4123
4124 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4125
4126
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004127option http-keep-alive
4128no option http-keep-alive
4129 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4131 yes | yes | yes | yes
4132 Arguments : none
4133
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004134 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4135 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4136 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4137 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4138 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4139 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4140 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4141
4142 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4143 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004144 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4145 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4146 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4147 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4148 situations where this option may be useful :
4149
4150 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4151 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4152
4153 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4154 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4155
4156 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4157 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4158 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4159 request.
4160
4161 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4162 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004163 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4164 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4165 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004166
4167 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4168 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4169
4170 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4171 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4172 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4173 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4174 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4175 not set.
4176
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004177 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4178 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004179 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004180 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004181
4182 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004183 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4184 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004185
4186
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004187option http-no-delay
4188no option http-no-delay
4189 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4191 yes | yes | yes | yes
4192 Arguments : none
4193
4194 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4195 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4196 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4197 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4198 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4199 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4200 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4201 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4202 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4203 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4204 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4205 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4206 affected.
4207
4208 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4209 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4210 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4211 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4212 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4213 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4214 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4215 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4216 latency environments.
4217
4218
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004219option http-pretend-keepalive
4220no option http-pretend-keepalive
4221 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 yes | yes | yes | yes
4224 Arguments : none
4225
4226 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4227 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4228 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4229 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4230 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4231 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4232 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4233 consider the response complete.
4234
4235 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4236 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4237 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4238 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4239 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4240 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4241
4242 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4243 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4244 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4245 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4246 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4247 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4248 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4249
4250 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4251 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004252 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004253 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4254 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004255
4256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4258
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004259 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4260 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004261
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004262
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004263option http-server-close
4264no option http-server-close
4265 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | yes | yes | yes
4268 Arguments : none
4269
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004270 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4271 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4272 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4273 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4274 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4275 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4276 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4277 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4278 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4279 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4280 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4281 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4282 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4283 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4284 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4285 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004286
4287 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4288 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4289 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4290 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004291 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4292 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004293
4294 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4295 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004296 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4297 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004298 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4299 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004300
4301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4303
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004304 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004305 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4306 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004307
4308
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004309option http-tunnel
4310no option http-tunnel
4311 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 yes | yes | yes | yes
4314 Arguments : none
4315
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004316 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4317 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4318 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4319 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4320 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4321 "option http-tunnel".
4322
4323 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004324 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004325 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4326 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4327 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4328 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4329 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4330 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4331 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004332
4333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4335
4336 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4337 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4338 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4339
4340
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004341option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004342no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004343 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4345 yes | yes | yes | no
4346 Arguments : none
4347
4348 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4349 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4350 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4351 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4352 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4353 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4354 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4355
4356 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4357 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4358 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4359 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4360 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4361 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4362 request along its whole life.
4363
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004364 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4365 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4366 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4367 front of an existing proxy.
4368
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004369 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4370
4371 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4372 http-server-close".
4373
4374
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004375option httpchk
4376option httpchk <uri>
4377option httpchk <method> <uri>
4378option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4379 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | no | yes | yes
4382 Arguments :
4383 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4384 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4385 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4386 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4387 ones.
4388
4389 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4390 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4391 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4392
4393 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4394 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4395 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4396 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4397 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4398
4399 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4400 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4401 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4402 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4403 the lack of any response.
4404
4405 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4406
4407 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4408 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4409 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4410
4411 Examples :
4412 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4413 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4414 backend https_relay
4415 mode tcp
4416 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4417 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4418
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004419 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4420 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4421 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004422
4423
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004424option httpclose
4425no option httpclose
4426 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4428 yes | yes | yes | yes
4429 Arguments : none
4430
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004431 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4432 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4433 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4434 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004435 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004436 "option http-tunnel".
4437
4438 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4439 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4440 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4441 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4442 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4443 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4444 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4445 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004446
4447 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004448 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004449 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4450 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4451 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4452 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4453 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004454
4455 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4456 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004457 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4458 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004459 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4460 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004461
4462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4464
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004465 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4466 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004467
4468
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004469option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004470 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004473 Arguments :
4474 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4475 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4476 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4477 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4478 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004479
4480 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4481 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4482 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4483 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4484 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4485 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4486 ports.
4487
4488 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4489
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004490 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4491 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004493 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004494
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004495
4496option http_proxy
4497no option http_proxy
4498 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4500 yes | yes | yes | yes
4501 Arguments : none
4502
4503 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4504 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4505 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4506 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4507 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4508
4509 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4510 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4511 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4512 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004513 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004514 be analyzed.
4515
4516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4518
4519 Example :
4520 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4521 backend direct_forward
4522 option httpclose
4523 option http_proxy
4524
4525 See also : "option httpclose"
4526
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004527
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004528option independent-streams
4529no option independent-streams
4530 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | yes | yes | yes
4533 Arguments : none
4534
4535 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4536 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4537 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4538 receive data or not.
4539
4540 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4541 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4542 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4543 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4544 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4545 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4546 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4547 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4548 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4549 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4550 socket buffers.
4551
4552 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4553 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4554 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4555 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4556 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004558 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004559 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4560 deprecated.
4561
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004562 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004563
4564
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004565option ldap-check
4566 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 yes | no | yes | yes
4569 Arguments : none
4570
4571 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4572 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4573 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4574 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4575
4576 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4577 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4578
4579 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4580 configure it.
4581
4582 Example :
4583 option ldap-check
4584
4585 See also : "option httpchk"
4586
4587
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004588option log-health-checks
4589no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004590 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4592 yes | no | yes | yes
4593 Arguments : none
4594
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004595 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4596 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4597 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004598
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004599 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4600 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4601 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4602 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4603 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4604
4605 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4606 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004607
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004608 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4609 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4610 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004611
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004612
4613option log-separate-errors
4614no option log-separate-errors
4615 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4617 yes | yes | yes | no
4618 Arguments : none
4619
4620 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4621 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4622 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4623 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4624 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4625 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4626 provides very important information.
4627
4628 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4629 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4630 error logs.
4631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004632 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004633 logging.
4634
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004635
4636option logasap
4637no option logasap
4638 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4640 yes | yes | yes | no
4641 Arguments : none
4642
4643 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4644 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4645 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4646 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4647 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4648 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4649 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004650 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004651 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4652 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4653
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004654 Examples :
4655 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4656 mode http
4657 option httplog
4658 option logasap
4659 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4660
4661 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4662 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4663 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4664 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004666 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004667 logging.
4668
4669
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004670option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004671 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004674 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004675 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4676 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004677 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004678
4679 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4680 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4681 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4682 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4683 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4684 in the MySQL table, like this :
4685
4686 USE mysql;
4687 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4688 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4689
4690 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4691 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4692 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4693 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4694 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4695 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4696 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4697 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4698 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4699
4700 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4701 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004702
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004703 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004704
4705 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4706 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4707 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4708 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4709 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4710 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4711
4712 See also: "option httpchk"
4713
4714
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004715option nolinger
4716no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004717 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004718 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4719 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004720 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004721
4722 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4723 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4724 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4725 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4726 connections.
4727
4728 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4729 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4730 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4731 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4732 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4733 this too.
4734
4735 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4736 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4737 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4738
4739 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4740 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4741 for servers.
4742
4743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4745
4746
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004747option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4748 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4750 yes | yes | yes | yes
4751 Arguments :
4752 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4753 matching <network>
4754 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4755 header name.
4756
4757 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4758 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4759 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4760 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4761 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4762 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4763 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4764 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4765 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4766 possible that the client has already brought one.
4767
4768 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4769 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4770 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4771 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4772 header and requires different one.
4773
4774 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4775 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4776 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4777 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4778 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4779 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4780 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4781
4782 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4783 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4784 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4785 both are defined.
4786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004787 Examples :
4788 # Original Destination address
4789 frontend www
4790 mode http
4791 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4792
4793 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4794 backend www
4795 mode http
4796 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4797
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004798 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4799 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004800
4801
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004802option persist
4803no option persist
4804 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004807 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004808
4809 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4810 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4811 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4812 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4813 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4814 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4815 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4816 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4817 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4818 redirected to another valid server.
4819
4820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4822
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004823 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004824
4825
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004826option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4827 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 yes | no | yes | yes
4830 Arguments :
4831 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4832 PostgreSQL server.
4833
4834 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4835 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4836 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4837 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4838
4839 See also: "option httpchk"
4840
4841
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004842option prefer-last-server
4843no option prefer-last-server
4844 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 yes | no | yes | yes
4847 Arguments : none
4848
4849 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4850 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4851 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4852 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4853 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4854 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4855 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4856 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4857 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004858 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4859 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4860 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4861 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4862 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4863 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4864 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004865
4866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4868
4869 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4870
4871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004872option redispatch
4873no option redispatch
4874 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004877 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004878
4879 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4880 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4881 be able to access the service anymore.
4882
4883 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4884 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4885
4886 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4887 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4888 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004890 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4891 "redisp" keywords.
4892
4893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4895
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004896 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004897
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004898
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004899option redis-check
4900 Use redis health checks for server testing
4901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4902 yes | no | yes | yes
4903 Arguments : none
4904
4905 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4906 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4907 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4908 find the "+PONG" response message.
4909
4910 Example :
4911 option redis-check
4912
4913 See also : "option httpchk"
4914
4915
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004916option smtpchk
4917option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4918 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004921 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004922 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4923 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4924 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4925
4926 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4927 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4928 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4929
4930 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4931 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4932 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4933 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4934 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4935 dead server.
4936
4937 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4938 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4939 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4940 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4941
4942 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4943 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4944 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4945 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4946 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4947
4948 Example :
4949 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4950
4951 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004954option socket-stats
4955no option socket-stats
4956
4957 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4959 yes | yes | yes | no
4960
4961 Arguments : none
4962
4963
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004964option splice-auto
4965no option splice-auto
4966 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4968 yes | yes | yes | yes
4969 Arguments : none
4970
4971 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4972 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4973 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4974 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004975 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004976 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4977 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4978 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4979 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4980
4981 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4982 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4983 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4984 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4985 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4986 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4987 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4988 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4989 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4990 keyword.
4991
4992 Example :
4993 option splice-auto
4994
4995 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4996 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4997
4998 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4999 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5000
5001
5002option splice-request
5003no option splice-request
5004 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | yes | yes | yes
5007 Arguments : none
5008
5009 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005010 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005011 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5012 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5013 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5014 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5015
5016 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5017
5018 Example :
5019 option splice-request
5020
5021 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5022 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5023
5024 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5025 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5026
5027
5028option splice-response
5029no option splice-response
5030 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 yes | yes | yes | yes
5033 Arguments : none
5034
5035 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005036 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005037 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5038 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5039 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5040 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5041
5042 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5043
5044 Example :
5045 option splice-response
5046
5047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5049
5050 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5051 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5052
5053
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005054option srvtcpka
5055no option srvtcpka
5056 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | no | yes | yes
5059 Arguments : none
5060
5061 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5062 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5063 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5064 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5065
5066 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5067 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5068 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5069 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5070
5071 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5072 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5073 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5074 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5075 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5076
5077 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5078
5079 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5080 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5081 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5082
5083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5085
5086 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5087
5088
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005089option ssl-hello-chk
5090 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | no | yes | yes
5093 Arguments : none
5094
5095 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5096 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5097 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5098 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5099 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5100 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5101 hello message.
5102
5103 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5104 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5105 messages, which is appreciable.
5106
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005107 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5108 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5109 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005110
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005111 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5112
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005113
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005114option tcp-check
5115 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5116 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 yes | no | yes | yes
5118
5119 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5120 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5121
5122 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5123 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5124 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5125
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005126 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005127 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5128 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5129 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5130 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5131 only.
5132
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005133 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005134 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5135 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5136 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5137 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5138
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005139 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005140 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5141 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005142 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005143 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5144 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5145 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5146 the respective protocols.
5147 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5148 analysed.
5149
5150 Examples :
5151 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5152 option tcp-check
5153 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5154
5155 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5156 option tcp-check
5157 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5158
5159 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5160 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005161 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005162 option tcp-check
5163 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5164 tcp-check expect +PONG
5165 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5166 tcp-check expect string role:master
5167 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5168 tcp-check expect string +OK
5169
5170 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5171 (send many headers before analyzing)
5172 option tcp-check
5173 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5174 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5175 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5176 tcp-check send \r\n
5177 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5178
5179
5180 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5181
5182
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005183option tcp-smart-accept
5184no option tcp-smart-accept
5185 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | yes | yes | no
5188 Arguments : none
5189
5190 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5191 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5192 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5193 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5194 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5195 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5196
5197 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5198 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5199 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5200 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5201
5202 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5203 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5204 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5205 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5206
5207 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5208 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5209 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5210
5211 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5212 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5213 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5214
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005215 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5216
5217
5218option tcp-smart-connect
5219no option tcp-smart-connect
5220 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | no | yes | yes
5223 Arguments : none
5224
5225 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5226 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5227 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5228 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5229 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5230
5231 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5232 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5233 complex.
5234
5235 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5236 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5237 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5238
5239 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5240 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5241
5242 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5243
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005244
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005245option tcpka
5246 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 yes | yes | yes | yes
5249 Arguments : none
5250
5251 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5252 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5253 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5254 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5255
5256 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5257 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5258 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5259 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5260
5261 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5262 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5263 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5264 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5265 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5266
5267 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5268
5269 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5270 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5271 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5272 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5273 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5274 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5275 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5276 backends.
5277
5278 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5279
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005280
5281option tcplog
5282 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5284 yes | yes | yes | yes
5285 Arguments : none
5286
5287 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5288 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5289 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5290 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5291 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5292 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5293 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5294 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5295
5296 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005298 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005299
5300
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005301option transparent
5302no option transparent
5303 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005305 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005306 Arguments : none
5307
5308 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5309 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5310 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5311 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5312 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5313 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5314 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5315 appropriate server.
5316
5317 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5318 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5319
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005320 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005321 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005322
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005323
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005324persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005325persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005326 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329 Arguments :
5330 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005331 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5332 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005333
5334 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5335 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5336 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5337 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5338 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5339 forwarded to this server.
5340
5341 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5342 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5343 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005344 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005345 a single "listen" section.
5346
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005347 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5348 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5349 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5350
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005351 Example :
5352 listen tse-farm
5353 bind :3389
5354 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5355 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5356 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5357 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5358 persist rdp-cookie
5359 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005360 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005361 balance rdp-cookie
5362 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5363 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5364
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005365 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5366 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005367
5368
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005369rate-limit sessions <rate>
5370 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 yes | yes | yes | no
5373 Arguments :
5374 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5375 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5376
5377 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5378 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5379 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5380 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5381 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5382 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5383
5384 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5385 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5386 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5387 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5388
5389 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5390 listen smtp
5391 mode tcp
5392 bind :25
5393 rate-limit sessions 10
5394 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5395
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005396 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5397 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5398 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005399
5400 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5401
5402
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005403redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5404redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5405redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005406 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 no | yes | yes | yes
5409
5410 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005411 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005412
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005414 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005415 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5416 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5417 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005418
5419 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5420 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5421 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5422 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5423 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005424 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5425 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5426 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5427 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005428
5429 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5430 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5431 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5432 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5433 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5434 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005435 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005436 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005437 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5438 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5439 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005440
5441 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005442 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5443 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5444 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5445 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5446 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5447 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5448 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5449 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005450
5451 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5452 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5453
5454 - "drop-query"
5455 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5456 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5457 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5458 with a location-type redirect.
5459
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005460 - "append-slash"
5461 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5462 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5463 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5464 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5465
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005466 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5467 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5468 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5469 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5470 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5471 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5472 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5473
5474 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5475 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5476 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5477 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5478 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5479 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5480 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005481
5482 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5483 acl clear dst_port 80
5484 acl secure dst_port 8080
5485 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005486 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005487 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005488 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5489
5490 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005491 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5492 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5493 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005494 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005495
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005496 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5497 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5498 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5499
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005500 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005501 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005502
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005503 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5504 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5505 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005507 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005508
5509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005510redisp (deprecated)
5511redispatch (deprecated)
5512 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5514 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005515 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005516
5517 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5518 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5519 be able to access the service anymore.
5520
5521 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5522 redistribute them to a working server.
5523
5524 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5525 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5526 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005528 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5529 "option redispatch" instead.
5530
5531 See also : "option redispatch"
5532
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005533
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005534reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005535 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 no | yes | yes | yes
5538 Arguments :
5539 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5540 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005541 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005542
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005543 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5544 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5545
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5547 the last header of an HTTP request.
5548
5549 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5550 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5551 responses.
5552
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005553 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5554 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5555 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5556
5557 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5558 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005559
5560
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005561reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5562reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005563 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 no | yes | yes | yes
5566 Arguments :
5567 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5568 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5569 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5570 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5571 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5572 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5573 ignores case.
5574
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005575 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5576 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5577
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005578 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5579 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5580 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5581 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005582 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005583
5584 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5585 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5586
5587 Example :
5588 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5589 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5590 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5591
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005592 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5593 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005594
5595
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005596reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5597reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005598 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 no | yes | yes | yes
5601 Arguments :
5602 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5603 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5604 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5605 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5606 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5607 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5608
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005609 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5610 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5611
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005612 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5613 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5614 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5615 next servers.
5616
5617 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5618 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5619 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5620
5621 Example :
5622 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5623 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5624 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5625
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005626 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5627 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005628
5629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005630reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5631reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5634 no | yes | yes | yes
5635 Arguments :
5636 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5637 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5638 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5639 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5640 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5641 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5642 case.
5643
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005644 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5645 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5646
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005647 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5648 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5649 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5650 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005651 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005652
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005653 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005654 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005655 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005656
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5658 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5659
5660 Example :
5661 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5662 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5663 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5664
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005665 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5666 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005667
5668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005669reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5670reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005671 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 no | yes | yes | yes
5674 Arguments :
5675 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5676 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5677 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5678 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5679 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5680 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5681 case.
5682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005683 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5684 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5685
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005686 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5687 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5688 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5689 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5690
5691 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5692 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5693
5694 Example :
5695 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5696 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5697 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5698 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5699
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005700 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5701 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702
5703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005704reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5705reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005706 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 no | yes | yes | yes
5709 Arguments :
5710 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5711 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5712 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5713 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5714 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5715 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5716
5717 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5718 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5719 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5720 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005721 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005722
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005723 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5724 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5725
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005726 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5727 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5728 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5729
5730 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5731 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5732 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5733 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5734 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5735
5736 Example :
5737 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005738 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005739 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5740 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5741
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005742 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5743 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005744
5745
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005746reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5747reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005748 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5750 no | yes | yes | yes
5751 Arguments :
5752 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5753 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5754 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5755 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5756 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5757 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5758 ignores case.
5759
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005760 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5761 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5762
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005763 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5764 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005765 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5766 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5767 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005768 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5769 not set.
5770
5771 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5772 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5773 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5774 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5775 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5776
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005777 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005778 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5779 # block all others.
5780 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5781 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5782
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005783 # block bad guys
5784 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5785 reqitarpit . if badguys
5786
5787 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5788 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005789
5790
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005791retries <value>
5792 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5794 yes | no | yes | yes
5795 Arguments :
5796 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5797 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5798 default value is 3.
5799
5800 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5801 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5802 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5803
5804 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5805 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5806
5807 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5808 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5809
5810 See also : "option redispatch"
5811
5812
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005813rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005814 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 no | yes | yes | yes
5817 Arguments :
5818 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5819 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005820 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005821
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005822 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5823 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5824
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005825 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5826 the last header of an HTTP response.
5827
5828 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5829 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5830 responses.
5831
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005832 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5833 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005834
5835
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005836rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5837rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005838 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 no | yes | yes | yes
5841 Arguments :
5842 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5843 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5844 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5845 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5846 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5847 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5848 ignores case.
5849
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005850 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5851 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5852
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005853 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5854 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005855 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005856 client.
5857
5858 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5859 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5860 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5861
5862 Example :
5863 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005864 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005865
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005866 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5867 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005868
5869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005870rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5871rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005872 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 no | yes | yes | yes
5875 Arguments :
5876 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5877 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5878 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5879 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5880 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5881 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5882 ignores case.
5883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005884 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5885 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5886
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005887 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5888 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5889 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5890 case-sensitive.
5891
5892 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005893 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5894 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5895 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005896
5897 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5898 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5899
5900 Example :
5901 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5902 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5903
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005904 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5905 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005906
5907
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005908rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5909rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005910 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5912 no | yes | yes | yes
5913 Arguments :
5914 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5915 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5916 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5917 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5918 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5919 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5920 ignores case.
5921
5922 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5923 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5924 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5925 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005926 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005927
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005928 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5929 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5930
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005931 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5932 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5933 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5934
5935 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5936 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5937 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5938 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5939 are not case-sensitive.
5940
5941 Example :
5942 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5943 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5944
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005945 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5946 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005947
5948
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005949server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005950 Declare a server in a backend
5951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 no | no | yes | yes
5953 Arguments :
5954 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005955 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005956 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005957
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005958 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5959 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5960 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5961 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005962 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5963 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5964 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5965 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5966 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005967 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5968 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5969 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5970 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5971 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5972 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5973 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005974 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005975 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5976 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5977 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5978 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005979
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005980 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005981 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5982 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5983 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5984 adding this value to the client's port.
5985
5986 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5987 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005988 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005989
5990 Examples :
5991 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5992 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005993 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005994 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5995 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5996 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005997
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005998 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5999 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006000
6001
6002source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006003source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006004source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006005 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 yes | no | yes | yes
6008 Arguments :
6009 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6010 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006011
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006012 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006013 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6014 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6015 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6016 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6017 supported prefixes are :
6018 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6019 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6020 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006021 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006022 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6023 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6024 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6025 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006026
6027 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6028 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006029 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6030 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6031 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006032
6033 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6034 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6035 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6036 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6037 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6038 <addr>.
6039
6040 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6041 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6042 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6043 port.
6044
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006045 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6046 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6047 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6048 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006049 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006050 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6051 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6052 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6053 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6054 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6055 HTTP header.
6056
6057 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6058 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006059 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006060 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6061 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6062 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6063 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6064 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6065 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6066 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6067
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006068 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6069 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6070 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6071 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6072 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6073 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6074
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006075 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6076 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6077 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6078 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6079
6080 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6081 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6082 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6083 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6084 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6085 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6086
6087 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6088 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6089 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6090 there are two methods :
6091
6092 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6093 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6094 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6095 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6096 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6097 of the client ranges may be used.
6098
6099 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6100 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6101 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6102 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6103 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6104 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6105 same session.
6106
6107 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6108 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6109 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6110 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6111 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6112 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6113
6114 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6115 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6116 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006117 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006118
6119 Examples :
6120 backend private
6121 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6122 source 192.168.1.200
6123
6124 backend transparent_ssl1
6125 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6126 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6127
6128 backend transparent_ssl2
6129 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6130 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6131 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6132
6133 backend transparent_ssl3
6134 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6135 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6136 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6137
6138 backend transparent_smtp
6139 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6140 # with Tproxy version 4.
6141 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6142
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006143 backend transparent_http
6144 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6145 # proxy.
6146 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006148 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006149 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006151
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006152srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6153 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6155 yes | no | yes | yes
6156 Arguments :
6157 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6158 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6159 as explained at the top of this document.
6160
6161 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6162 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6163 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6164 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6165 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6166 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6167 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6168
6169 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6170 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6171 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6172 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6173 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006174 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006175 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006176 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006177
6178 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6179 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6180 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6181 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6182 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6183 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6184
6185 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6186 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6187
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006188 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6189 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006190
6191
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006192stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6193 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006195 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006196
6197 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6198 matched.
6199
6200 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6201 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006203 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6204 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6205 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6206
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006207 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6208 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6209 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6210 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006211
6212 Example :
6213 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6214 backend stats_localhost
6215 stats enable
6216 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6217
6218 Example :
6219 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6220 backend stats_auth
6221 stats enable
6222 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6223 stats admin if TRUE
6224
6225 Example :
6226 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6227 userlist stats-auth
6228 group admin users admin
6229 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6230 group readonly users haproxy
6231 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6232
6233 backend stats_auth
6234 stats enable
6235 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6236 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6237 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6238 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6239
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006240 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6241 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6242 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006243
6244
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006245stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6246 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006248 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006249 Arguments :
6250 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6251
6252 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6253
6254 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6255 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6256 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6257 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6258 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6259 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6260
6261 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6262 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6263 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006264 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006265
6266 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6267 report using "stats scope".
6268
6269 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6270 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6271 unobvious parameters.
6272
6273 Example :
6274 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6275 backend public_www
6276 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6277 stats enable
6278 stats hide-version
6279 stats scope .
6280 stats uri /admin?stats
6281 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6282 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6283 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6284
6285 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6286 backend private_monitoring
6287 stats enable
6288 stats uri /admin?stats
6289 stats refresh 5s
6290
6291 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6292
6293
6294stats enable
6295 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006297 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006298 Arguments : none
6299
6300 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6301 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6302 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6303 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6304 - stats auth : no authentication
6305 - stats scope : no restriction
6306
6307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6309 unobvious parameters.
6310
6311 Example :
6312 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6313 backend public_www
6314 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6315 stats enable
6316 stats hide-version
6317 stats scope .
6318 stats uri /admin?stats
6319 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6320 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6321 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6322
6323 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6324 backend private_monitoring
6325 stats enable
6326 stats uri /admin?stats
6327 stats refresh 5s
6328
6329 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6330
6331
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006332stats hide-version
6333 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006335 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006336 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006337
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006338 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6339 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6340 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6341 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6342 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6343 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6347 unobvious parameters.
6348
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006349 Example :
6350 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6351 backend public_www
6352 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006353 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006354 stats hide-version
6355 stats scope .
6356 stats uri /admin?stats
6357 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6358 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6359 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006360
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006361 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6362 backend private_monitoring
6363 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006364 stats uri /admin?stats
6365 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006366
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006367 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006368
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006369
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006370stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6371 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6372 Access control for statistics
6373
6374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 no | no | yes | yes
6376
6377 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6378 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6379 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6380 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6381 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6382 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6383
6384 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6385 instance.
6386
6387 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6388 about ACL usage.
6389
6390
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006391stats realm <realm>
6392 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006394 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006395 Arguments :
6396 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6397 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6398 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6399
6400 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6401 using a backslash ('\').
6402
6403 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6404 only related to authentication.
6405
6406 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6407 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6408 unobvious parameters.
6409
6410 Example :
6411 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6412 backend public_www
6413 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6414 stats enable
6415 stats hide-version
6416 stats scope .
6417 stats uri /admin?stats
6418 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6419 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6420 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6421
6422 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6423 backend private_monitoring
6424 stats enable
6425 stats uri /admin?stats
6426 stats refresh 5s
6427
6428 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6429
6430
6431stats refresh <delay>
6432 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006434 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006435 Arguments :
6436 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6437 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6438 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6439 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6440 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6441 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6442
6443 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6444 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6445 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6446 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6447
6448 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6449 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6450 unobvious parameters.
6451
6452 Example :
6453 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6454 backend public_www
6455 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6456 stats enable
6457 stats hide-version
6458 stats scope .
6459 stats uri /admin?stats
6460 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6461 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6462 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6463
6464 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6465 backend private_monitoring
6466 stats enable
6467 stats uri /admin?stats
6468 stats refresh 5s
6469
6470 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6471
6472
6473stats scope { <name> | "." }
6474 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006476 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006477 Arguments :
6478 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6479 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6480 section in which the statement appears.
6481
6482 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6483 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6484 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6485 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6486 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6487 exists.
6488
6489 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6490 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6491 unobvious parameters.
6492
6493 Example :
6494 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6495 backend public_www
6496 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6497 stats enable
6498 stats hide-version
6499 stats scope .
6500 stats uri /admin?stats
6501 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6502 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6503 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6504
6505 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6506 backend private_monitoring
6507 stats enable
6508 stats uri /admin?stats
6509 stats refresh 5s
6510
6511 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6512
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006513
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006514stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006515 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006517 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006518
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006519 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006520 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6521
6522 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6523 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6524
6525 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6526 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006527 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006528
6529 Example :
6530 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6531 backend private_monitoring
6532 stats enable
6533 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6534 stats uri /admin?stats
6535 stats refresh 5s
6536
6537 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6538 global section.
6539
6540
6541stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006542 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 yes | yes | yes | yes
6545 Arguments : none
6546
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006547 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006548 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6549 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6550 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6551 - IP (socket, server)
6552 - cookie (backend, server)
6553
6554 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6555 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006556 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006557
6558 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6559
6560
6561stats show-node [ <name> ]
6562 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006564 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006565 Arguments:
6566 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6567 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6568
6569 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6570 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006571 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006572
6573 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6574 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6575 unobvious parameters.
6576
6577 Example:
6578 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6579 backend private_monitoring
6580 stats enable
6581 stats show-node Europe-1
6582 stats uri /admin?stats
6583 stats refresh 5s
6584
6585 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6586 section.
6587
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006588
6589stats uri <prefix>
6590 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006592 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006593 Arguments :
6594 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6595 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6596 query string.
6597
6598 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6599 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6600 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6601 possible to reach it in the application.
6602
6603 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006604 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006605 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6606 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6607 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6608 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6609
6610 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6611 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6612 an address or a port to statistics only.
6613
6614 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6615 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6616 unobvious parameters.
6617
6618 Example :
6619 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6620 backend public_www
6621 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6622 stats enable
6623 stats hide-version
6624 stats scope .
6625 stats uri /admin?stats
6626 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6627 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6628 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6629
6630 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6631 backend private_monitoring
6632 stats enable
6633 stats uri /admin?stats
6634 stats refresh 5s
6635
6636 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6637
6638
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006639stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6640 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006642 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006643
6644 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006645 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006646 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6647 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6648 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6649
6650 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6651 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6652 the "stick-table" statement.
6653
6654 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6655 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6656 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6657 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6658 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6659
6660 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6661 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6662 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6663 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6664 transformation rules.
6665
6666 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6667 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6668 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6669 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6670 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6671 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6672 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6673
6674 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6675 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6676 ACL based conditions.
6677
6678 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6679 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6680 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6681 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6682
6683 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6684 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6685 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6686 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6687
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006688 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6689 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6690 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6691
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006692 Example :
6693 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6694 # last 30 minutes
6695 backend pop
6696 mode tcp
6697 balance roundrobin
6698 stick store-request src
6699 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6700 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6701 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6702
6703 backend smtp
6704 mode tcp
6705 balance roundrobin
6706 stick match src table pop
6707 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6708 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6709
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006710 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006711 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006712
6713
6714stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6715 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6717 no | no | yes | yes
6718
6719 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6720 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6721 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6722 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6723
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006724 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6725 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6726 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6727
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006728 Examples :
6729 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006730 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006731
6732 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6733 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6734 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6735
6736
6737 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6738 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6739 backend http
6740 mode http
6741 balance roundrobin
6742 stick on src table https
6743 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6744 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6745 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6746
6747 backend https
6748 mode tcp
6749 balance roundrobin
6750 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6751 stick on src
6752 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6753 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6754
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006755 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006756
6757
6758stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6759 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 no | no | yes | yes
6762
6763 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006764 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006765 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6766 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6767 server is selected.
6768
6769 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6770 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6771 the "stick-table" statement.
6772
6773 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6774 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6775 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6776 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6777 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6778 address.
6779
6780 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6781 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6782 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6783 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6784 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6785 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6786 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6787 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6788 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6789 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6790
6791 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6792 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6793 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6794 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6795 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6796 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6797 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6798
6799 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6800 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6801 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6802 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6803
6804 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6805 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6806 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6807 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6808 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6809 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006810 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6811 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6812 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6813 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6814 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6815 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006816
6817 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6818 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6819 the request.
6820
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006821 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6822 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6823 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6824
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006825 Example :
6826 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6827 # last 30 minutes
6828 backend pop
6829 mode tcp
6830 balance roundrobin
6831 stick store-request src
6832 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6833 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6834 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6835
6836 backend smtp
6837 mode tcp
6838 balance roundrobin
6839 stick match src table pop
6840 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6841 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6842
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006843 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006844 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006845
6846
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006847stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006848 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6849 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006850 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006852 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006853
6854 Arguments :
6855 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6856 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6857 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6858 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6859
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006860 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6861 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6862 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6863 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6864
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006865 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6866 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6867 instance.
6868
6869 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6870 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6871 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6872 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6873 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6874 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006875 to 32 characters.
6876
6877 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6878 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6879 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006880 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006881 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6882 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006883
6884 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006885 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6886 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006887 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6888 increase.
6889
6890 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006891 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6892 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6893 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006894
6895 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6896 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6897 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6898 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6899 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6900 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6901 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6902 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6903 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6904 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6905 parameter (see below).
6906
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006907 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6908 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6909 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6910 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6911 soft restart.
6912
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006913 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6914
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006915 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6916 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6917 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6918 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6919 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006920 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006921 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6922 if not expiration delay is specified.
6923
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006924 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6925 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6926 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6927 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006928 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6929 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6930 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6931 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6932 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6933 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6934 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6935 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6936 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6937 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6938 types and their arguments.
6939
6940 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6941 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6942 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6943 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6944
6945 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6946 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6947 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6948 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6949
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006950 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6951 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6952 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6953 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6954 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6955 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6956
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006957 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6958 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6959 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6960 they were received.
6961
6962 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6963 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6964 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6965 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6966 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6967
6968 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6969 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6970 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6971 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6972 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6973
6974 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6975 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6976 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6977
6978 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6979 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6980 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6981 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6982 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6983
6984 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6985 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6986 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6987 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6988 the client side.
6989
6990 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6991 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6992 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6993 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6994 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6995 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6996 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6997
6998 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6999 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7000 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7001 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7002 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7003 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7004 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7005
7006 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7007 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7008 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7009 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7010 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7011 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7012
7013 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7014 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7015 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7016 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7017
7018 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7019 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7020 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7021 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7022 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7023 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7024 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7025 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7026 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7027 recommended for better fairness.
7028
7029 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7030 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7031 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7032 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7033
7034 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7035 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7036 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7037 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7038 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7039 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7040 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7041 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7042 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7043 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007044
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007045 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7046 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007047 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7048 reference it.
7049
7050 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7051 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7052 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7053 as an exclusive stickiness.
7054
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007055 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7056 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7057 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7058 something that can be ignored.
7059
7060 Example:
7061 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7062 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7063 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7064 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7065
7066 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007067 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007068
7069
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007070stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7071 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7073 no | no | yes | yes
7074
7075 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007076 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007077 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7078 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7079 server is selected.
7080
7081 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7082 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7083 the "stick-table" statement.
7084
7085 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7086 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7087 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7088 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7089
7090 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7091 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7092 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7093 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7094 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7095 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007096 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007097 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7098 rules.
7099
7100 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7101 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7102 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7103 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7104 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7105 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7106 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7107
7108 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7109 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7110 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7111 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7112
7113 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7114 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7115 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7116 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7117 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7118 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007119 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7120 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7121 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7122 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7123 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7124 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7125 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7126 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7127 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007128
7129 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7130
7131 Example :
7132 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7133 backend https
7134 mode tcp
7135 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007136 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007137 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007138
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007139 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7140 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7141
7142 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7143 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7144 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7145
7146 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7147 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007148
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007149 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7150 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7151 # at offset 44.
7152
7153 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7154 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7155
7156 # Learn on response if server hello.
7157 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007158
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007159 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7160 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7161
7162 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7163 extraction.
7164
7165
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007166tcp-check connect [params*]
7167 Opens a new connection
7168 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7169 no | no | yes | yes
7170
7171 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7172 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7173 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7174
7175 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7176 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7177 of the sequence.
7178
7179 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7180 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7181 do.
7182
7183 Parameters :
7184 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7185 use the TCP connection.
7186
7187 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7188 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7189 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7190
7191 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7192
7193 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7194
7195 Examples:
7196 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7197 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7198 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7199 option tcp-check
7200 tcp-check connect
7201 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7202 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7203 tcp-check send \r\n
7204 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7205 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7206 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7207 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7208 tcp-check send \r\n
7209 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7210 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7211
7212 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7213 option tcp-check
7214 tcp-check connect port 110
7215 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7216 tcp-check connect port 143
7217 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7218 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7219
7220 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7221
7222
7223tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7224 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7226 no | no | yes | yes
7227
7228 Arguments :
7229 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7230 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7231 binary.
7232 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7233 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7234 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7235
7236 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7237 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7238 with the usual backslash ('\').
7239 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7240 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7241 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7242 used upper or lower case.
7243
7244
7245 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7246
7247 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7248 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7249 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7250 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7251 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7252 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7253 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7254 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7255
7256 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7257 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7258 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7259 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7260 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7261 expression.
7262
7263 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7264 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7265 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7266 this exact hexadecimal string.
7267 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7268
7269 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7270 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7271 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7272 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7273 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7274 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7275 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7276 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7277 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7278 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7279 the null character.
7280
7281 Examples :
7282 # perform a POP check
7283 option tcp-check
7284 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7285
7286 # perform an IMAP check
7287 option tcp-check
7288 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7289
7290 # look for the redis master server
7291 option tcp-check
7292 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7293 tcp-check expect +PONG
7294 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7295 tcp-check expect string role:master
7296 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7297 tcp-check expect string +OK
7298
7299
7300 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7301 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7302
7303
7304tcp-check send <data>
7305 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7307 no | no | yes | yes
7308
7309 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7310 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7311
7312 Examples :
7313 # look for the redis master server
7314 option tcp-check
7315 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7316 tcp-check expect string role:master
7317
7318 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7319 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7320
7321
7322tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7323 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7324 tcp health check
7325 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 no | no | yes | yes
7327
7328 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7329 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7330 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7331 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7332 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7333 hexadecimal string.
7334 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7335
7336 Examples :
7337 # redis check in binary
7338 option tcp-check
7339 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7340 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7341
7342
7343 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7344 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7345
7346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007347tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7348 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007351 Arguments :
7352 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007353 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7354 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007356 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007357
7358 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7359 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007360 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7361 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7362 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7363 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7364 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7365 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007366
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007367 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7368 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7369 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7370 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007371
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007372 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007373 - accept :
7374 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7375 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7376 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007378 - reject :
7379 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7380 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7381 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7382 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7383 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7384 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7385 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7386 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7387 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7388 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7389 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7390 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007391
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007392 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7393 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7394 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7395 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7396 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7397 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7398 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7399 hosts.
7400
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007401 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7402 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7403 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7404 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7405 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7406 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7407 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7408 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7409 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7410 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7411 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7412
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007413 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007414 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7415 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7416 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007417 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7418 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007419 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007420 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7421 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7422 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7423 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7424 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007426 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007427 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007428 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007429 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7430 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7431 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7432 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007434 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7435 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7436 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7437 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007438
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007439 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7440 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7441 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7442 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7443 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007444 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7445 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7446 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7447 layer7 information is extracted.
7448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007449 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7450 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7451 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7452 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7453 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007454
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007455 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7456 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7457 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007459 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7460 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7461 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007463 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007464 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007465 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007467 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7468 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7469 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007471 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007472 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7473 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007474
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007475 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7476
7477 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7478
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007479 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7480
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007482
7483
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007484tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7485 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007487 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007488 Arguments :
7489 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007490 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007491 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7492 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007494 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007496 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7497 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7498 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7499 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7500 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007502 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7503 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7504 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7505 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007506 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7507 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7508 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7509 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7510 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7511 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007512 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007513 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007514
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007515 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7516 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7517 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7518 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007519
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007520 Four types of actions are supported :
7521 - accept : the request is accepted
7522 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7523 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007524 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007525
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007526 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7527 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007528
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007529 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7530 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7531 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7532 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7533 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7534 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007536 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007537 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7538 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007541 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7542 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7543 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7544 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007545 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7546 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7547 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007548
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007549 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007550 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7551 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7552 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007553
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007554 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007555 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7556 # and reject everything else.
7557 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7558 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007559 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007560 tcp-request content reject
7561
7562 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007563 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7564 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7565 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007566 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007567
7568 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7569 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7570 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007571 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007572 tcp-request content reject
7573
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007574 Example:
7575 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7576 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007577 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007578
7579 Example:
7580 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7581 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007582 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007584 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7585 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7586
7587 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007588 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007589 # protecting all our sites
7590 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007591 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7592 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007593 ...
7594 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7595
7596 backend http_dynamic
7597 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007598 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007599 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007600 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7601 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7602 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007603 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007605 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007607 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007608
7609
7610tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7611 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007613 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007614 Arguments :
7615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7617 as explained at the top of this document.
7618
7619 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7620 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7621 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7622 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7623 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7624
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007625 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7626 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7627 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7628 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7629
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007630 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7631 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007632 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007633 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007634 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7635 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7636 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7637 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007638
7639 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7640 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7641 it pass through unaffected.
7642
7643 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7644 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7645 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007646 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007647 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7648 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007649 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7650 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7651 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007652
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007653 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007654 "timeout client".
7655
7656
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007657tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7658 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7660 no | no | yes | yes
7661 Arguments :
7662 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007663 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007664
7665 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7666
7667 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7668 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7669 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007670 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7671 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007672
7673 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7674
7675 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7676 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7677 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7678 inserted.
7679
7680 Two types of actions are supported :
7681 - accept :
7682 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7683 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7684 the rules evaluation.
7685
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007686 - close :
7687 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7688 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7689 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7690 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7691 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7692 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007693 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007694 protocols.
7695
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007696 - reject :
7697 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7698 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007699 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007700
7701 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7702 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7703 for changing the default action to a reject.
7704
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007705 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7706 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7707 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7708 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007709 period.
7710
7711 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7712
7713 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7714
7715
7716tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7717 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 no | no | yes | yes
7720 Arguments :
7721 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7722 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7723 as explained at the top of this document.
7724
7725 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7726
7727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007728timeout check <timeout>
7729 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7730 established.
7731
7732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7733 yes | no | yes | yes
7734 Arguments:
7735 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7736 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7737 as explained at the top of this document.
7738
7739 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7740 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7741 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7742 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007743 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7744 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7745 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007746
7747 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7748 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7749
7750 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7751 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007752 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007753
7754 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7755 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7756 forget about it.
7757
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007758 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7759 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007760
7761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007762timeout client <timeout>
7763timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7764 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7766 yes | yes | yes | no
7767 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007768 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7770 as explained at the top of this document.
7771
7772 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7773 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7774 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7775 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7776 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7777 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7778 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7779 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007780 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007781 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007782 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7783 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007784 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7785 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007786
7787 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7788 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7789 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7790 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7791 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7792 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7793
7794 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7795 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7796 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7797
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007798 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007799
7800
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007801timeout client-fin <timeout>
7802 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7804 yes | yes | yes | no
7805 Arguments :
7806 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7808 as explained at the top of this document.
7809
7810 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7811 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7812 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7813 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7814 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7815 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7816 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7817 down in one direction.
7818
7819 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7820 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7821 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7822
7823 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7824
7825
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007826timeout connect <timeout>
7827timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7828 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 yes | no | yes | yes
7831 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7834 as explained at the top of this document.
7835
7836 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007837 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007838 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007839 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007840 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7841 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007842
7843 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7844 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7845 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7846 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7847 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7848 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7849
7850 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7851 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7852 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7853
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007854 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7855 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007856
7857
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007858timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7859 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | yes | yes | yes
7862 Arguments :
7863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7865 as explained at the top of this document.
7866
7867 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7868 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7869 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7870 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7871 once the request has started to present itself.
7872
7873 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7874 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7875 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7876 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7877 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7878
7879 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7880 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7881 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7882 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7883
7884 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7885 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7886 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7887 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7888 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007889 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007890
7891 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7892 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7893 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7894 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7895
7896 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7897
7898
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007899timeout http-request <timeout>
7900 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007902 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007903 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007904 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007905 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7906 as explained at the top of this document.
7907
7908 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7909 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7910 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7911 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7912 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7913 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7914 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007915 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7916 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7917 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7918 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7919 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007920 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
7921 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007922
7923 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7924 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007925 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7926 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007927
7928 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7929 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7930 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7931 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7932 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7933
7934 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007935 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7936 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7937 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007938
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007939 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
7940 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007941
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007942
7943timeout queue <timeout>
7944 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 yes | no | yes | yes
7947 Arguments :
7948 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7949 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7950 as explained at the top of this document.
7951
7952 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7953 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7954 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7955 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7956 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7957
7958 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7959 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7960 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7961 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7962
7963 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7964
7965
7966timeout server <timeout>
7967timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7968 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 yes | no | yes | yes
7971 Arguments :
7972 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7973 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7974 as explained at the top of this document.
7975
7976 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7977 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7978 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7979 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7980 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7981 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7982 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7983
7984 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7985 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7986 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7987 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7988 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007989 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007990 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007991 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7992 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7993 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7994 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007995
7996 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7997 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7998 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7999 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8000 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8001 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8002
8003 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8004 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8005 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8006
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008007 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008008
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008009
8010timeout server-fin <timeout>
8011 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8013 yes | no | yes | yes
8014 Arguments :
8015 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8016 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8017 as explained at the top of this document.
8018
8019 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8020 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8021 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8022 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8023 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8024 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8025 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8026 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8027 situations, it should not be needed.
8028
8029 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8030 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8031 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8032
8033 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8034
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008035
8036timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008037 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8039 yes | yes | yes | yes
8040 Arguments :
8041 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8043 as explained at the top of this document.
8044
8045 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8046 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8047 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8048
8049 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8050 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8051 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8052 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008053 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008054
8055 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8056
8057
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008058timeout tunnel <timeout>
8059 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8061 yes | no | yes | yes
8062 Arguments :
8063 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8064 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8065 as explained at the top of this document.
8066
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008067 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008068 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8069 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8070 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8071 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8072 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8073 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8074 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8075 specified.
8076
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008077 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8078 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8079 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8080 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8081 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8082 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8083 state.
8084
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008085 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8086 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8087 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8088 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8089 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8090
8091 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8092 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8093 forget about it.
8094
8095 Example :
8096 defaults http
8097 option http-server-close
8098 timeout connect 5s
8099 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008100 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008101 timeout server 30s
8102 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8103
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008104 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008105
8106
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008107transparent (deprecated)
8108 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008110 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008111 Arguments : none
8112
8113 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8114 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8115 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8116 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8117 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8118 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8119 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8120 appropriate server.
8121
8122 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8123
8124 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8125 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8126
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008127 See also: "option transparent"
8128
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008129unique-id-format <string>
8130 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8132 yes | yes | yes | no
8133 Arguments :
8134 <string> is a log-format string.
8135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008136 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8137 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8138 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8139 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008140
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008141 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8142 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8143 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8144 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8145 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8146 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8147 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8148 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008149
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008150 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8151 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008152
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008153 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008154
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008155 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008156
8157 will generate:
8158
8159 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8160
8161 See also: "unique-id-header"
8162
8163unique-id-header <name>
8164 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8166 yes | yes | yes | no
8167 Arguments :
8168 <name> is the name of the header.
8169
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008170 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8171 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008172
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008173 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008174
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008175 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008176 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8177
8178 will generate:
8179
8180 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8181
8182 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008183
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008184use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008185 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 no | yes | yes | no
8188 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008189 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8190 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008191
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008192 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8193 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008194
8195 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8196 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8197 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008198 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8199 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8200 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8201 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008202
8203 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8204 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8205 assign the backend.
8206
8207 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8208 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8209 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8210 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8211 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8212 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8213
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008214 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008215 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008216 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8217 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8218 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8219
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008220 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8221 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8222 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8223 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8224 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8225 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8226 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8227 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8228 cannot be forced from the request.
8229
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008230 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008231 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8232 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8233
8234 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8235 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008236
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008237
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008238use-server <server> if <condition>
8239use-server <server> unless <condition>
8240 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8242 no | no | yes | yes
8243 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008244 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008245
8246 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8247
8248 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8249 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8250 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8251
8252 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8253 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8254 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8255 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8256 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8257 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8258 matches will assign the server.
8259
8260 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8261 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8262 with the next rules until one matches.
8263
8264 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8265 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8266 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8267 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8268
8269 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8270 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8271 stripped.
8272
8273 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8274 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8275 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8276 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8277
8278 Example :
8279 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8280 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8281 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8282 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8283 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8284 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8285 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8286 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8287 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8288
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008289 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008290
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008291
82925. Bind and Server options
8293--------------------------
8294
8295The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8296depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8297settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8298written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8299described in this section.
8300
8301
83025.1. Bind options
8303-----------------
8304
8305The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8306as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8307no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8308parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8309while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8310provided immediately after the setting name.
8311
8312The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8313
8314accept-proxy
8315 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008316 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8317 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008318 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8319 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8320 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8321 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8322 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8323 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8324 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008325 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8326 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008327
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008328alpn <protocols>
8329 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8330 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8331 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8332 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8333 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8334 initial NPN extension.
8335
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008336backlog <backlog>
8337 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8338 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8339
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008340ecdhe <named curve>
8341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008342 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8343 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008344
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008345ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8347 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8348 client's certificate.
8349
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008350ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8352 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8353 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8354 error is ignored.
8355
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008356ciphers <ciphers>
8357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8358 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008359 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008360 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8361 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8362
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008363crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8365 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8366 to verify client's certificate.
8367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008368crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8370 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8371 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8372 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8373 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8374 file.
8375
8376 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8377 are loaded.
8378
8379 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008380 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8381 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8382 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8383 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8384 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8385 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8386 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008387 www.sub.example.org).
8388
8389 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8390 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8391 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8392 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008393 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8394 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008395
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008396 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008397
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008398 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8399 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008400 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008401 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8402 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8403 clients).
8404
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008405 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8406 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8407 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8408 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8409 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8410 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8411 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8412 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8413 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8414 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8415 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8416 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8417 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8418
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008419crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8421 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008422 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008423 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008424
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008425crt-list <file>
8426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008427 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8428 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008429
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008430 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008431
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008432 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8433 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8434 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8435 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8436 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8437 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8438 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8439 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008440
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008441defer-accept
8442 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8443 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8444 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8445 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8446 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8447 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8448 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8449 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8450 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8451 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8452 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8453
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008454force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008455 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008456 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008457 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8458 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008459
8460force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008461 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008462 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8463 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008464
8465force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008466 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008467 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8468 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008469
8470force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008471 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008472 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8473 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008475gid <gid>
8476 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8477 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8478 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8479 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8480 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8481
8482group <group>
8483 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8484 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8485 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8486 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8487 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8488
8489id <id>
8490 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8491 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8492 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8493 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8494
8495interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008496 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8497 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8498 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8499 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8500 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8501 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8502 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008503
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008504level <level>
8505 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8506 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8507 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8508 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8509 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8510 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8511 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8512 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8513 counters).
8514 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8515 all counters).
8516
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008517maxconn <maxconn>
8518 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8519 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8520 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8521 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8522 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8523 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8524 eat all memory.
8525
8526mode <mode>
8527 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8528 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8529 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8530 UNIX sockets.
8531
8532mss <maxseg>
8533 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8534 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8535 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8536 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8537 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8538 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8539 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8540 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8541 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8542 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8543 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8544
8545name <name>
8546 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8547 page.
8548
8549nice <nice>
8550 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8551 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8552 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8553 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8554 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8555 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8556 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8557 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8558 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8559 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8560 one for an RDP socket.
8561
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008562no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008564 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008565 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008566 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8567 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008568 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008569
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008570no-tls-tickets
8571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8572 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8573 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008574 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8575 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008576
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008577no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008579 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008580 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008581 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8582 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8583 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008584
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008585no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008587 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008588 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008589 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8590 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8591 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008592
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008593no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008595 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008596 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008597 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8598 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8599 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008600
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008601npn <protocols>
8602 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8603 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8604 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8605 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008606 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8607 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008608
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008609process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8610 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8611 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8612 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8613 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8614 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8615 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8616 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008617 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8618 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8619 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8620 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8621 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8622 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8623 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008624
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008625ssl
8626 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008627 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008628 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8629 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8630 to deciphered contents.
8631
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008632strict-sni
8633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8634 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8635 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8636 See the "crt" option for more information.
8637
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008638tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008639 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008640 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8641 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8642 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8643 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8644 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8645 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8646 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008647 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8648 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8649 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008650
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008651transparent
8652 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8653 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8654 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8655 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8656 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8657 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8658 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8659 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8660 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8661 so check for support with your vendor.
8662
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008663v4v6
8664 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8665 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8666 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8667 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008668 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008669
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008670v6only
8671 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8672 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8673 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008674 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8675 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008676
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008677uid <uid>
8678 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8679 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8680 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8681 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8682 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8683
8684user <user>
8685 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8686 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8687 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8688 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8689 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8690
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008691verify [none|optional|required]
8692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8693 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8694 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8695 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8696 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008697 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8698 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8699 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8700 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087025.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008703------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008705The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8706which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8707arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8708settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8709after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8710Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8711address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008713 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008714 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008716The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008717
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008718addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008719 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8720 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8721 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8722 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8723 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008725 Supported in default-server: No
8726
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008727agent-check
8728 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008729 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8730 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8731 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8732 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008733
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008734 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008735 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008736 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8737 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8738 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008740 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8741 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008742
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008743 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8744 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8745 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008746
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008747 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8748 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8749 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008750
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008751 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8752 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8753 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8754 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8755 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8756 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8757 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008759 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8760 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008761
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008762 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8763 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8764 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8765 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8766 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8767 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8768 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8769 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8770 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008771
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008772 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8773 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008774 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8775 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8776 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8777 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008778
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008779 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8780 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008781
8782 Supported in default-server: No
8783
8784agent-inter <delay>
8785 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8786 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8787
8788 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8789 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8790 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8791 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8792 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8793 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8794 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8795 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8796 of backends use the same servers.
8797
8798 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8799
8800 Supported in default-server: Yes
8801
8802agent-port <port>
8803 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8804
8805 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8806
8807 Supported in default-server: Yes
8808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008809backup
8810 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8811 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8812 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8813 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8814 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8815 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008817 Supported in default-server: No
8818
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008819ca-file <cafile>
8820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8821 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8822 server's certificate.
8823
8824 Supported in default-server: No
8825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008826check
8827 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008828 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8829 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8830 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8831 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8832 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8833 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8834 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008835 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8836 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8837 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008839 Supported in default-server: No
8840
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008841check-send-proxy
8842 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8843 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8844 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8845 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8846 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8847 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8848 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8849
8850 Supported in default-server: No
8851
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008852check-ssl
8853 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8854 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8855 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8856 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008857 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008858 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8859 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8860 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8861 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8862
8863 Supported in default-server: No
8864
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008865ciphers <ciphers>
8866 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008867 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008868 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8869 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8870 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8871 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8872 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8873 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8874
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008875 Supported in default-server: No
8876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008877cookie <value>
8878 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8879 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8880 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8881 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8882 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8883 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8884 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008886 Supported in default-server: No
8887
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008888crl-file <crlfile>
8889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8890 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8891 to verify server's certificate.
8892
8893 Supported in default-server: No
8894
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008895crt <cert>
8896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8897 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8898 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8899 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8900 certificate request.
8901
8902 Supported in default-server: No
8903
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008904disabled
8905 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8906 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8907 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8908 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8909 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8910
8911 Supported in default-server: No
8912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008913error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008914 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8915 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8916 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008918 Supported in default-server: Yes
8919
8920 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008922fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008923 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8924 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8925 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008927 Supported in default-server: Yes
8928
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008929force-sslv3
8930 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8931 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008932 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8933 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008934
8935 Supported in default-server: No
8936
8937force-tlsv10
8938 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008939 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8940 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008941
8942 Supported in default-server: No
8943
8944force-tlsv11
8945 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008946 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8947 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008948
8949 Supported in default-server: No
8950
8951force-tlsv12
8952 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008953 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8954 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008955
8956 Supported in default-server: No
8957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008958id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008959 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8960 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8961 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008963 Supported in default-server: No
8964
8965inter <delay>
8966fastinter <delay>
8967downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008968 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8969 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8970 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8971 between checks depending on the server state :
8972
8973 Server state | Interval used
8974 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8975 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8976 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8977 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8978 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8979 or yet unchecked. |
8980 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8981 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8982 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008984 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8985 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8986 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8987 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008988 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8989 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8990 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8991 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8992 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008994 Supported in default-server: Yes
8995
8996maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8998 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8999 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9000 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9001 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9002 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9003 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9004 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009006 Supported in default-server: Yes
9007
9008maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009009 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9010 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9011 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9012 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9013 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9014 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9015 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009017 Supported in default-server: Yes
9018
9019minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009020 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9021 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9022 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9023 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9024 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9025 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009026 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009027 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009029 Supported in default-server: Yes
9030
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009031no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009032 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9033 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009034 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009035
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009036 Supported in default-server: No
9037
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009038no-tls-tickets
9039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9040 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9041 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009042 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9043 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009044
9045 Supported in default-server: No
9046
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009047no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009048 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009049 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9050 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009051 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9052 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9053 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009054
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009055 Supported in default-server: No
9056
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009057no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009058 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009059 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9060 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009061 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9062 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9063 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009064
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009065 Supported in default-server: No
9066
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009067no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009068 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009069 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9070 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009071 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9072 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9073 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009074
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009075 Supported in default-server: No
9076
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009077non-stick
9078 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9079 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9080 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9081
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009082 Supported in default-server: No
9083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009084observe <mode>
9085 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9086 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9087 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9088 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9089 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9090 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009091 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009093 Supported in default-server: No
9094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009095 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009097on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009098 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9099 Currently, four modes are available:
9100 - fastinter: force fastinter
9101 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9102 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9103 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9104 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009106 Supported in default-server: Yes
9107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009108 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9109
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009110on-marked-down <action>
9111 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9112 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009113 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9114 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9115 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9116 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9117 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9118 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9119 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9120 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009121
9122 Actions are disabled by default
9123
9124 Supported in default-server: Yes
9125
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009126on-marked-up <action>
9127 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9128 Currently one action is available:
9129 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9130 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9131 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9132 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9133 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9134 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9135 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9136 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9137
9138 Actions are disabled by default
9139
9140 Supported in default-server: Yes
9141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009142port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009143 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9144 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9145 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9146 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9147 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9148 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009150 Supported in default-server: Yes
9151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009152redir <prefix>
9153 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9154 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9155 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9156 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9157 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9158 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9159 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9160 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009161 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009162 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9163 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9164 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9165 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9166 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9167
9168 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009170 Supported in default-server: No
9171
9172rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009173 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9174 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9175 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009177 Supported in default-server: Yes
9178
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009179send-proxy
9180 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9181 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9182 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9183 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9184 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9185 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9186 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9187 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9188 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009189 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9190 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9191 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9192 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9193 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009194
9195 Supported in default-server: No
9196
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009197send-proxy-v2
9198 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9199 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9200 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9201 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9202 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9203 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9204 option of the "bind" keyword.
9205
9206 Supported in default-server: No
9207
9208send-proxy-v2-ssl
9209 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9210 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9211 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9212 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9213 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9214 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9215 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9216 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9217
9218 Supported in default-server: No
9219
9220send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9221 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9222 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9223 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9224 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9225 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9226 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9227 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9228 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9229 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9230
9231 Supported in default-server: No
9232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009233slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009234 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9235 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9236 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9237 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9238 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9239 parameters :
9240
9241 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9242 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9243
9244 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9245 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9246 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9247 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9248
9249 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9250 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9251 seen as failed.
9252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009253 Supported in default-server: Yes
9254
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009255source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009256source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009257source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009258 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9259 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9260 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9261 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9262
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009263 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9264 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9265 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9266 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9267 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9268 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9269 server.
9270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009271 Supported in default-server: No
9272
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009273ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009274 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9275 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9276 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9277 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9278 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9279 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009280 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009281
9282 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009284track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009285 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9286 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9287 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9288 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009291 Supported in default-server: No
9292
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009293verify [none|required]
9294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009295 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9296 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9297 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9298 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009299 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9300 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9301 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009302
9303 Supported in default-server: No
9304
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009305verifyhost <hostname>
9306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9307 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9308 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9309 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9310 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9311 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9312
9313 Supported in default-server: No
9314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009315weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009316 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9317 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9318 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009319 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9320 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9321 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9322 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9323 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9324 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009326 Supported in default-server: Yes
9327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009328
93296. HTTP header manipulation
9330---------------------------
9331
9332In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9333response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9334request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9335which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009336against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009338If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9339to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9340but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9341HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9342stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9343because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9344a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9345still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009347This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9348in section 4.2 :
9349
9350 - reqadd <string>
9351 - reqallow <search>
9352 - reqiallow <search>
9353 - reqdel <search>
9354 - reqidel <search>
9355 - reqdeny <search>
9356 - reqideny <search>
9357 - reqpass <search>
9358 - reqipass <search>
9359 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9360 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9361 - reqtarpit <search>
9362 - reqitarpit <search>
9363 - rspadd <string>
9364 - rspdel <search>
9365 - rspidel <search>
9366 - rspdeny <search>
9367 - rspideny <search>
9368 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9369 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9370
9371With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9372is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9373parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9374prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9375Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9376
9377 \t for a tab
9378 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9379 \n for a new line (LF)
9380 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9381 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9382 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9383 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9384 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9385
9386The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9387portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9388above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9389regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93909 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9391is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9392
9393The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9394after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9395
9396Notes related to these keywords :
9397---------------------------------
9398 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9399 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9400 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9401
9402 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9403 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9404 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9405
9406 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9407 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9408 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9409 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9410 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9411
9412 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9413 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9414 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9415 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9416 useless headers before adding new ones.
9417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009418 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009419 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9420
9421 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9422 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9423 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9424
9425 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9426 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009427 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009428
9429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094307. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9431----------------------------------
9432
9433Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9434client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9435The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9436these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9437but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9438data called patterns.
9439
9440
94417.1. ACL basics
9442---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009443
9444The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9445content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9446from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9447simple :
9448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009449 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009450 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009451 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9452 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9455adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009456
9457In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009459 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009460
9461This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9462Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9463and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009464an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9465conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9466as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9467are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009468
9469ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9470'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9471which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9472
9473There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9474performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009476The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9477specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9478this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009479methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9480ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481
9482Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9483 - boolean
9484 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9485 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9486 - string
9487 - data block
9488
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009489Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9490converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9491would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9492The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9493which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9494
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009495Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9496keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9497fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9498which are summarized in the table below :
9499
9500 +---------------------+-----------------+
9501 | Sample or converter | Default |
9502 | output type | matching method |
9503 +---------------------+-----------------+
9504 | boolean | bool |
9505 +---------------------+-----------------+
9506 | integer | int |
9507 +---------------------+-----------------+
9508 | ip | ip |
9509 +---------------------+-----------------+
9510 | string | str |
9511 +---------------------+-----------------+
9512 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9513 +---------------------+-----------------+
9514
9515Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9516matching method, see below.
9517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009518The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9519 - boolean
9520 - integer or integer range
9521 - IP address / network
9522 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9523 - regular expression
9524 - hex block
9525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009526The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9527
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009528 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9529 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009530 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009531 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009532 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009533 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009534 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009536The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9537read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9538if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9539lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9540will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9541beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9542a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9543lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9544exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9545
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009546The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9547parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9548ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9549a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9550check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9551
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009552The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9553socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9554file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009556Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9557loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9558
9559 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9560
9561In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9562the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9563case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9564as well.
9565
9566The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9567sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9568do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9569methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9570is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9571obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9572followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9573default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9574that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9575string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9576
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009577The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9578By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9579string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9580resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9581server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9582waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9583flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9584function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009586There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9587sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9588be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009589
9590 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9591 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9593 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9594 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9595 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009596
9597 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9598 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009599 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009600
9601 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009602 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009603
9604 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009606
9607 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9608 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9609
9610 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9611 binary or string samples.
9612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009613 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9614 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9617 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9618 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009620 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9621 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009623 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9624 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009626 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9627 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9630 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009631 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9634 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9635 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009636
9637For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9638request, it is possible to do :
9639
9640 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9641
9642In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9643buffer, one would use the following acl :
9644
9645 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9646
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009647On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9648possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9649
9650 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9653criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9654method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9655to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9656criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9657the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009659If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009660the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9661For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009663 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9664 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9665 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9666 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009667
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009668
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009669The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9670types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9671combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9672brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9673default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009675 +-------------------------------------------------+
9676 | Input sample type |
9677 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009678 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9680 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9681 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009682 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009683 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009684 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009685 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009686 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009688 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009689 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009690 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009692 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009694 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009696 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009698 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009700 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009702 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9704 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009706
9707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097087.1.1. Matching booleans
9709------------------------
9710
9711In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9712Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9713When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9714that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9715
9716Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9717return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9718"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097217.1.2. Matching integers
9722------------------------
9723
9724Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9725enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9726to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9727
9728Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9729matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9730lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009731
9732For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9733unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9734representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9735
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009736As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9737two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9738instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9739ranges and operators.
9740
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009741For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009742operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9743Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9744of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009746Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009747
9748 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9749 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9750 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9751 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9752 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009754For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009755
9756 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9757
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009758This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9759
9760 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097637.1.3. Matching strings
9764-----------------------
9765
9766String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9767different forms :
9768
9769 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9770 patterns ;
9771
9772 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9773 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9774
9775 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9776 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9777
9778 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9779 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9780
9781 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9782 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9783 matches.
9784
9785 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9786 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9787 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009788
9789String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9790exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9791characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9792string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9793to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009794before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009795
9796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097977.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9798---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009799
9800Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9801they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9802possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9803passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9804the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009805the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9806match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009807
9808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098097.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9810-------------------------------------
9811
9812It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9813not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9814a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9815to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9816digits may be used upper or lower case.
9817
9818Example :
9819 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9820 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9821
9822
98237.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9824---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009825
9826IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9827netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9828within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009829host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009830difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9831at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9832does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9833parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009834
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009835IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9836Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9837trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9838IPv6 patterns.
9839
9840HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9841following situations :
9842 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9843 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9844 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9845 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9846 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9847 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9848 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9849 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9850 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9851 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009853
98547.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9855----------------------------------
9856
9857Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9858combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9859
9860 - AND (implicit)
9861 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9862 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009864A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009866 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009868Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9869indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9872"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9873requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9874is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9875
9876 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9877 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9878 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9879 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9880
9881To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9882and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9883
9884 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9885 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9886 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9887 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9888
9889 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9890 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9891 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9892 use_backend www if host_www
9893
9894It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9895expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9896be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9897the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9898
9899 The following rule :
9900
9901 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9902 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9903
9904 Can also be written that way :
9905
9906 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9907
9908It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9909to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9910simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9911sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9912good use is the following :
9913
9914 With named ACLs :
9915
9916 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9917 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9918 monitor fail if site_dead
9919
9920 With anonymous ACLs :
9921
9922 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9923
9924See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9925
9926
99277.3. Fetching samples
9928---------------------
9929
9930Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9931against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9932sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9933ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9934of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9935available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9936
9937This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9938Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9939compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9940deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9941
9942The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9943matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9944method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9945indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9946
9947As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9948when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9949mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9950the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9951ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9952
9953Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9954multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9955when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9956incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9957are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9958is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9959all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9960
9961Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9962 - name
9963 - name(arg1)
9964 - name(arg1,arg2)
9965
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009966
99677.3.1. Converters
9968-----------------
9969
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009970Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9971of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9972is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9973was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9974has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9975unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9976
9977These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9978sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9979the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9980support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009983
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009984base64
9985 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9986 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9987 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9988
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009989hex
9990 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9991 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9992 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9993 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009995http_date([<offset>])
9996 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9997 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9998 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9999 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10000 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10001 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010002
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010003ipmask(<mask>)
10004 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10005 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10006 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10007 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010009language(<value>[,<default>])
10010 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10011 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10012 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10013 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10014 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10015 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10016 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10017 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10018 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10019 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10020 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10021 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010022
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010023 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010025 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10026 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010028 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10029 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10030 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10031 use_backend spanish if es
10032 use_backend french if fr
10033 use_backend english if en
10034 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010035
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010036lower
10037 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10038 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10039 type. The result is of type string.
10040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010041map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10042map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10043map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10044 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10045 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10046 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10047 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10048 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10049 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10050 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10051 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010053 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10054 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10055 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010056
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010057 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10058 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010059
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010060 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10061 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10062 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010064 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010066 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10068 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10070 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10072 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10074 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10076 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10078 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010080
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010081 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10082 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10083 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10084 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10085 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010087 Example :
10088
10089 # this is a comment and is ignored
10090 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10091 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10092 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10093 | | | `---------- value
10094 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10095 | `---------------------------- key
10096 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10097
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010098upper
10099 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10100 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10101 type. The result is of type string.
10102
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010103
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101047.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010105--------------------------------------------
10106
10107A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10108not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10109"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10110The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10111
10112always_false : boolean
10113 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10114 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10115
10116always_true : boolean
10117 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10118 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10119
10120avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010121 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10123 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10124 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10125 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10126 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10127 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10128 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10129 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10130 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10131 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10132 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10133 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10134 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010136be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010137 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10138 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10139 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10140 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10141 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10144 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10145 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10146 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10147 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10148 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10149 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010150
10151 Example :
10152 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10153 backend dynamic
10154 mode http
10155 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10156 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010158connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10159 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010160 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10162 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010163
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010164 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010165 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010166 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10167
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010168 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10169 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010170
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010171 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010172 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010173 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010174 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10175 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010177 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010178
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010179 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10180 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010182 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010183
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010184date([<offset>]) : integer
10185 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10186 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10187 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10188 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010189 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10190
10191 Example :
10192
10193 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10194 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010195
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010196env(<name>) : string
10197 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10198 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10199 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10200 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10201 certain way.
10202
10203 Examples :
10204 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10205 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10206
10207 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10208 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010210fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10211 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010212 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10213 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10215 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10216 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10217 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10218 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010220fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10221 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10222 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10223 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10224 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10225 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10226 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10227 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10228 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010229
10230 Example :
10231 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10232 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10233 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10234 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10235 frontend mail
10236 bind :25
10237 mode tcp
10238 maxconn 100
10239 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10240 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10241 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10242 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010243
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010244nbproc : integer
10245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10246 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10247 and debugging purposes.
10248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010249nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10251 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10252 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010253 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10254 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10255 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010256
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010257proc : integer
10258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10259 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10260 debugging purposes.
10261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010262queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010263 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10264 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10265 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010266 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10267 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10268 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10269 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10270 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10271
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010272rand([<range>]) : integer
10273 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10274 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10275 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10276 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10277 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010279srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10280 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10281 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10282 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10283 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10284 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10285 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10286 methods.
10287
10288srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10289 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10290 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10291 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10292 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10293 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10294 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10295 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10296
10297srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10298 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10299 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010300 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010301 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10302 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10303 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10304 overloading servers).
10305
10306 Example :
10307 # Redirect to a separate back
10308 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10309 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10310 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10311
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010312stopping : boolean
10313 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10314 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10315 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10318 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10319 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10320
10321table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10322 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10323 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10324 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10325
10326
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103277.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010328----------------------------------
10329
10330The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10331closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10332methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10333sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10334TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010335the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10336counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10337"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010338argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10339the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10340this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010341
10342be_id : integer
10343 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10344 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10345
10346dst : ip
10347 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10348 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10349 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10350 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10351 RFC 4291.
10352
10353dst_conn : integer
10354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10355 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10356 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10357 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10358 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10359 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10360 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10361 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010363dst_port : integer
10364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10365 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10366 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10367 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10368 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10369 an HTTP header.
10370
10371fe_id : integer
10372 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10373 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10374 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010376sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010377sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10378sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10379sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10381 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10382 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010384sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010385sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10386sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10387sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010388 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10389 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10390 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010392sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010393sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10394sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10395sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010396 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10397 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010398 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10399 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10400 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010401
10402 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10403 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010404 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10405 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10406 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010407 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10408 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010410sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010411sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10412sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10413sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010414 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10415 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10416
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010417sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010418sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10419sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10420sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010421 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10422 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10423 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010425sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010426sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10427sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10428sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010429 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10430 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10431 See also src_conn_rate.
10432
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010433sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010434sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10435sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10436sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010437 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010438 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010439
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010440sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010441sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10442sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10443sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010444 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10445 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10446 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010447 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10448 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10449 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010450
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010451sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010452sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10453sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10454sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010455 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10456 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10457 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10458
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010459sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010460sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10461sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10462sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10464 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10465 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10466 src_http_err_rate.
10467
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010468sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010469sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10470sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10471sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010472 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10473 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10474 src_http_req_cnt.
10475
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010476sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010477sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10478sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10479sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010480 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10481 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10482 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10483 src_http_req_rate.
10484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010485sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010486sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10487sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10488sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010489 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010490 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10491 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10492 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10493 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010494
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010495 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10496 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010497 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010499sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010500sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10501sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10502sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010503 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10504 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10505 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010507sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010508sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10509sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10510sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010511 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10512 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10513 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010515sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010516sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10517sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10518sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010519 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10520 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10521 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10522 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010523 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010524 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010526sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010527sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10528sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10529sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010530 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10531 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10532 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10533 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10534 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010535 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010537sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010538sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10539sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10540sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010541 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10542 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10543 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10544
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010545sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010546sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10547sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10548sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010549 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10550 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010551 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010552 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10553 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10555 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10556 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010558so_id : integer
10559 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10560 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10561 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010563src : ip
10564 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10565 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10566 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10567 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10568 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10569 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10570 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010571
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010572 Example:
10573 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10574 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10577 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10578 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10579 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010580 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010582src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10583 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10584 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010585 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010586 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010588src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10589 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10590 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10591 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10592 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10593 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10594 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010595
10596 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10597 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10598 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10599 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010600 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010601 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10602 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010605 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010607 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010608 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010611 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10613 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010614 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10617 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10618 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10619 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010620 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010623 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010624 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010625 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010626 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010629 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10632 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010633 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10634 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10635 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010637src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10638 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10639 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010640 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010641 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010642 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10645 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10646 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10647 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10648 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010649 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010651src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10652 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10653 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10654 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010655 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10658 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10659 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10660 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010661 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010662 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010664src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10665 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10666 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10667 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010668 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10670 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010671
10672 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010673 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010674 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010676src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010677 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10678 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10679 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10680 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10681 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010684 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10685 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10686 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10687 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10688 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010690src_port : integer
10691 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10692 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10693 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10694 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10697 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010698 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10699 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10700 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010701 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010703src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10704 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10705 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10706 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10707 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010708 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010710src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10711 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10712 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10713 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10714 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10715 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10716 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10717 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10718 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010719
10720 Example :
10721 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10722 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10723 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10724 listen ssh
10725 bind :22
10726 mode tcp
10727 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010728 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010730 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732srv_id : integer
10733 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10734 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10735 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010736
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010737
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107387.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10742closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10743when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10744usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010745future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010746
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010747ssl_bc : boolean
10748 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10749 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10750 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10751
10752ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10753 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10754 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10755
10756ssl_bc_cipher : string
10757 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10758 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10759
10760ssl_bc_protocol : string
10761 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10762 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10763
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010764ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010765 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010766 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10767 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010768
10769ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10770 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10771 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10772 if session was reused or not.
10773
10774ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10775 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10776 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010778ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10779 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10780 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10781 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10782 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10783 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010785ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10786 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10787 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10788 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10789 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010790
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010791ssl_c_der : binary
10792 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10793 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10794 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010796ssl_c_err : integer
10797 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10798 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10799 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10800 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10801 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010803ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10804 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10805 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10806 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10807 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10808 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10809 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10810 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10811 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813ssl_c_key_alg : string
10814 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10815 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10816 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010818ssl_c_notafter : string
10819 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10820 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10821 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010823ssl_c_notbefore : string
10824 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10825 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10826 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10829 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10830 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10831 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10832 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10833 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10834 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10835 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10836 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010838ssl_c_serial : binary
10839 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10840 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10841 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010843ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10844 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10845 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10846 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010847 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10848 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10849
10850 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010852ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10853 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10854 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10855 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010857ssl_c_used : boolean
10858 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10859 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010861ssl_c_verify : integer
10862 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10863 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10864 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10865 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010867ssl_c_version : integer
10868 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10869 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010870
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010871ssl_f_der : binary
10872 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10873 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10874 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010876ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10877 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10878 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10879 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10880 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010881 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010882 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10883 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10884 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010886ssl_f_key_alg : string
10887 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10888 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10889 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010891ssl_f_notafter : string
10892 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10893 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10894 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010896ssl_f_notbefore : string
10897 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10898 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10899 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010901ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10902 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10903 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10904 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10905 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10906 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10907 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10908 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10909 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911ssl_f_serial : binary
10912 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10913 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10914 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010915
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010916ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10917 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10918 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10919 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10922 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10923 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10924 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010926ssl_f_version : integer
10927 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10928 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10929
10930ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010931 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10932 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10933 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010935 Example :
10936 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10937 listen http-https
10938 bind :80
10939 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10940 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10941
10942ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10943 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10944 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10945
10946ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010947 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010948 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10949 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10950 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10951 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10952 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10953 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10954 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10955 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957ssl_fc_cipher : string
10958 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10959 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010962 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10963 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010964 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10965 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10966 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10967 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10970 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010971 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10972 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10973 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10974 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010976ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010977 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010978 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10979 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10980 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10981 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10982 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10983 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10984 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010986ssl_fc_protocol : string
10987 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10988 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010989
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010990ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010991 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010992 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10993 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010995ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10996 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10997 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10998 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10999 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001ssl_fc_sni : string
11002 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11003 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11004 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11005 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11006 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11007
11008 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11009 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11010 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011011 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11012 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011014 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11016 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11019 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11020 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011021
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011022
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110237.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011024------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11027sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11028only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11029For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11030be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11031can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11032sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11033for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11034content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011036payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11037 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11038 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11039 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11042 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11043 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11044 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046req.len : integer
11047req_len : integer (deprecated)
11048 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11049 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11050 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11051 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11052 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11053 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11054 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11055 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11058 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011059 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11060 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11061 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11062 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064 ACL alternatives :
11065 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011067req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11068 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11069 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11070 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11071 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011073 ACL alternatives :
11074 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011076 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078req.proto_http : boolean
11079req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11080 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11081 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11082 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11083 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11084 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11085 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11086 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011088 Example:
11089 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11090 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11091 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011092 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11095rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11096 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11097 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11098 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11099 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11100 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11101 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11102 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011104 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11105 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11106 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11107 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11108 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11109 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011111 ACL derivatives :
11112 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011114 Example :
11115 listen tse-farm
11116 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11117 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11118 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11119 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11120 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11121 persist rdp-cookie
11122 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11123 # This is only useful makes sense if
11124 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11125 stick-table type string size 204800
11126 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11127 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11128 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11131 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011133req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11134rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11135 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11136 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11137 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11138 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011140 ACL derivatives :
11141 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011143req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11144req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11145 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11146 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11147 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11148 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11149 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11150 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11151 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011153req.ssl_sni : string
11154req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11155 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11156 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11157 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11158 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11159 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11160 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11161 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11162 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11163 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11164 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11165 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11166 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011168 ACL derivatives :
11169 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171 Examples :
11172 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11173 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11174 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11175 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11176 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11179rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11180 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11181 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11182 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11183 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11184 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11185 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11186 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188req.ssl_ver : integer
11189req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11190 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11191 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11192 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11193 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11194 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11195 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11196 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11197 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11198 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011200 ACL derivatives :
11201 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011202
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011203res.len : integer
11204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11205 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11206 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11207 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11208 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11209 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11210 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11211 content inspection.
11212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011213res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11214 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011215 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11216 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11217 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11218 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011220res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11221 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11222 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11223 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11224 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011226 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011228wait_end : boolean
11229 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11230 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11231 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11232 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11233 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11234 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11235 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11236 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011238 Examples :
11239 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11240 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11241 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011243 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11244 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11245 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11246 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11247 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11248 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11249 tcp-request content reject
11250
11251
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112527.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011253--------------------------------------
11254
11255It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11256This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11257data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11258its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11259HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11260content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11261to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11262more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11263response are indexed.
11264
11265base : string
11266 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11267 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11268 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11269 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11270 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11271 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11272 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11273 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11274
11275 ACL derivatives :
11276 base : exact string match
11277 base_beg : prefix match
11278 base_dir : subdir match
11279 base_dom : domain match
11280 base_end : suffix match
11281 base_len : length match
11282 base_reg : regex match
11283 base_sub : substring match
11284
11285base32 : integer
11286 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11287 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11288 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11289 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11290
11291base32+src : binary
11292 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11293 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11294 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11295 per-URL counters.
11296
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011297capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11298 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11299 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11300 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11301
11302capture.req.method : string
11303 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11304 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11305 because it's allocated.
11306
11307capture.req.uri : string
11308 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11309 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11310 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11311 allocated.
11312
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011313capture.req.ver : string
11314 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11315 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11316 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11317
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011318capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11319 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11320 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11321 The first entry is an index of 0.
11322 See also: "capture response header"
11323
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011324capture.res.ver : string
11325 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11326 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11327 persistent flag.
11328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011329req.cook([<name>]) : string
11330cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11331 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11332 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11333 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11334 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11335 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11336 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11337 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11338 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11339
11340 ACL derivatives :
11341 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11342 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11343 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11344 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11345 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11346 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11347 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11348 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11351cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11352 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11353 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011355req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11356cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11357 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11358 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11359 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11360 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011362cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11363 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11364 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11365 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11366 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11367 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11368 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11369 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11370 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11371 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11372 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011374hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11375 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11376 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11377 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11378 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011379 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11382 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11383 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11384 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11385 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11386 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11387 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11388 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11389 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011391req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11392 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11393 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11394 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11395 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011397req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11398 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11399 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11400 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11401 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11402 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11403 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11404 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11405 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11406 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11407 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11408 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011410 ACL derivatives :
11411 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11412 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11413 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11414 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11415 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11416 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11417 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11418 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11419
11420req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11421hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11422 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11423 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11424 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11425 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11426 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11427 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11428 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11429 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11430 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11431
11432req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11433hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11434 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11435 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11436 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11437 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11438 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11439 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11440 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11441 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11442
11443req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11444hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11445 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11446 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11447 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11448 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11449 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11450 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11451 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11452
11453http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11454 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11455 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11456 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11457 basic auth is supported.
11458
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011459http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11460 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11461 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11462 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11463 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011464 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11465 basic auth is supported.
11466
11467 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011468 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11469 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11470 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11471 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011472
11473http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011474 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11475 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011476 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11477 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479method : integer + string
11480 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11481 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11482 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11483 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11484 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11485 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11486 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488 ACL derivatives :
11489 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011491 Example :
11492 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11493 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11494 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011496path : string
11497 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11498 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11499 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11500 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11501 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11502 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11503 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505 ACL derivatives :
11506 path : exact string match
11507 path_beg : prefix match
11508 path_dir : subdir match
11509 path_dom : domain match
11510 path_end : suffix match
11511 path_len : length match
11512 path_reg : regex match
11513 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011515req.ver : string
11516req_ver : string (deprecated)
11517 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11518 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11519 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521 ACL derivatives :
11522 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011524res.comp : boolean
11525 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11526 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11527 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011529res.comp_algo : string
11530 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11531 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11532 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011534res.cook([<name>]) : string
11535scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11536 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11537 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11538 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540 ACL derivatives :
11541 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011543res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11544scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11545 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11546 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11547 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011549res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11550scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11551 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11552 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11553 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11556 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11557 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11558 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11559 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11560 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11561 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11562 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11563 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11564 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011566res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11567 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11568 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11569 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11570 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11571 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011573res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11574shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11575 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11576 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11577 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11578 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11579 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11580 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11581 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11582 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584 ACL derivatives :
11585 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11586 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11587 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11588 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11589 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11590 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11591 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11592 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11593
11594res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11595shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11596 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11597 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11598 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11599 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11600 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011602res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11603shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11604 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11605 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11606 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11607 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11608 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11609 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011611res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11612shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11613 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11614 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11615 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11616 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11617 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11618 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011620res.ver : string
11621resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11622 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11623 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011625 ACL derivatives :
11626 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011628set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11629 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11630 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11631 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11632 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11635 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011637 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639status : integer
11640 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11641 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11642 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011644url : string
11645 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11646 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11647 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11648 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11649 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11650 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11651 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011653 ACL derivatives :
11654 url : exact string match
11655 url_beg : prefix match
11656 url_dir : subdir match
11657 url_dom : domain match
11658 url_end : suffix match
11659 url_len : length match
11660 url_reg : regex match
11661 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011663url_ip : ip
11664 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11665 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11666 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11667 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11668 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11669 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11670 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672url_port : integer
11673 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11674 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11675 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11676 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011678urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11679url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11680 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11681 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11682 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11683 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11684 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11685 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11686 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11687 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11688 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011690 ACL derivatives :
11691 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11692 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11693 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11694 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11695 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11696 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11697 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11698 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011699
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011701 Example :
11702 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11703 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11704 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11705 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011707urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11708 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11709 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11710 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011711
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117137.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011714---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011716Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11717every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011718order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011720ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11721---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011723HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011724HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11725HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011726HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11727HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11728HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11729HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11730LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011731METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11732METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11733METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11734METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11735METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11736METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011737RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011738REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011739TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011740WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11741---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011742
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117448. Logging
11745----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011746
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011747One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11748provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11749very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11750provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11751state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011752to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011753headers.
11754
11755In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11756about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11757send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11758
11759 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11760 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11761 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11762 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11763 at the termination.
11764
11765The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11766allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11767as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11768while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11769real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11770delay.
11771
11772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117738.1. Log levels
11774---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011775
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011776TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011777source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011778HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11779in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11780track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11781syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11782about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011783
11784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117858.2. Log formats
11786----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011787
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011788HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011789and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11790slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11791options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011792
11793 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11794 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11795 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11796 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11797 extents.
11798
11799 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11800 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11801 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11802 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11803 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11804
11805 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11806 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11807 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11808 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11809 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11810
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011811 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11812 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11813 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11814 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11815
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011816 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11817
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011818Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11819specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11820field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11821servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11822always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11823identifier.
11824
11825Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11826 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11827 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11828 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11829 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11830
11831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118328.2.1. Default log format
11833-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011834
11835This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11836as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11837format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11838
11839 Example :
11840 listen www
11841 mode http
11842 log global
11843 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11844
11845 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11846 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11847 (www/HTTP)
11848
11849 Field Format Extract from the example above
11850 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11851 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11852 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11853 4 'to' to
11854 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11855 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11856
11857Detailed fields description :
11858 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11859 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11860 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11861 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11862 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11863 and processed the connection.
11864 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11865
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011866In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11867"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11868connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11869
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011870It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11871will eventually disappear.
11872
11873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118748.2.2. TCP log format
11875---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011876
11877The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11878is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11879information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11880counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11881emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11882environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11883the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11884sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011885specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11886not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11887fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11888marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011889
11890 Example :
11891 frontend fnt
11892 mode tcp
11893 option tcplog
11894 log global
11895 default_backend bck
11896
11897 backend bck
11898 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11899
11900 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11901 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11902 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11903
11904 Field Format Extract from the example above
11905 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11906 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11907 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11908 4 frontend_name fnt
11909 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11910 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11911 7 bytes_read* 212
11912 8 termination_state --
11913 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11914 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11915
11916Detailed fields description :
11917 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011918 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11919 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11920 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11921 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11922 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011923
11924 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011925 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11926 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11927 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011928
11929 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11930 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11931 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11932 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11933
11934 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11935 and processed the connection.
11936
11937 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11938 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11939 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11940 applications.
11941
11942 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11943 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11944 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11945 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11946 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11947
11948 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11949 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11950 See "Timers" below for more details.
11951
11952 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11953 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11954 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11955 "Timers" below for more details.
11956
11957 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011958 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011959 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11960 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11961 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11962 details.
11963
11964 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11965 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11966 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11967 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11968 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11969
11970 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11971 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11972 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11973 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11974 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11975 for more details.
11976
11977 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011978 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011979 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11980 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11981 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011982 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011983
11984 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11985 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11986 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11987 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11988 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11989 caused by a denial of service attack.
11990
11991 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11992 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11993 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11994 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11995 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11996 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11997 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11998 denial of service attack.
11999
12000 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12001 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12002 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12003 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12004 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12005 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12006 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12007 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12008 be processed than on other servers.
12009
12010 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12011 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12012 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12013 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12014 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12015 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12016 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12017 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12018 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12019 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12020 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12021 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12022 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12023
12024 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12025 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12026 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12027 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12028 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12029 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12030 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12031 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12032
12033 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12034 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12035 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12036 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12037 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12038 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12039 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12040 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12041 occurs.
12042
12043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120448.2.3. HTTP log format
12045----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012046
12047The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12048is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12049the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12050are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12051emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12052generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12053"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12054which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012055frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12056is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012057
12058Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12059slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12060with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12061
12062 Example :
12063 frontend http-in
12064 mode http
12065 option httplog
12066 log global
12067 default_backend bck
12068
12069 backend static
12070 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12071
12072 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12073 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12074 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012075 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012076
12077 Field Format Extract from the example above
12078 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12079 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12080 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12081 4 frontend_name http-in
12082 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12083 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12084 7 status_code 200
12085 8 bytes_read* 2750
12086 9 captured_request_cookie -
12087 10 captured_response_cookie -
12088 11 termination_state ----
12089 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12090 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12091 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12092 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12093 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012094
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012095
12096Detailed fields description :
12097 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012098 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12099 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12100 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12101 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12102 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012103
12104 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012105 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12106 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12107 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012108
12109 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12110 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12111 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12112 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12113 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12114
12115 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12116 and processed the connection.
12117
12118 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12119 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12120 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12121
12122 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12123 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12124 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12125 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12126 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12127 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12128
12129 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12130 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12131 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12132 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12133 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12134 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12135
12136 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12137 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12138 See "Timers" below for more details.
12139
12140 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12141 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12142 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12143 below for more details.
12144
12145 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12146 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12147 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12148 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12149 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12150 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12151 for more details.
12152
12153 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012154 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012155 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12156 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12157 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12158 details.
12159
12160 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12161 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12162 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12163
12164 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12165 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12166 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12167 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12168 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12169 overflowing.
12170
12171 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12172 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12173 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12174 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12175 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12176 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12177 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12178 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12179
12180 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12181 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12182 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12183 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12184 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12185 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12186 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12187 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12188
12189 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12190 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12191 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12192 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12193 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12194 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12195 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12196
12197 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012198 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012199 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12200 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12201 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012202 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012203 system.
12204
12205 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12206 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12207 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12208 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12209 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12210 caused by a denial of service attack.
12211
12212 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12213 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12214 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12215 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12216 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12217 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12218 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12219 denial of service attack.
12220
12221 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12222 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12223 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12224 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12225 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12226 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12227 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12228 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12229 processed than on other servers.
12230
12231 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12232 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12233 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12234 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12235 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12236 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12237 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12238 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12239 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12240 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12241 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12242 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12243 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12244
12245 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12246 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12247 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12248 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12249 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12250 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12251 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12252 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12253
12254 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12255 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12256 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12257 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12258 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12259 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12260 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12261 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12262 occurs.
12263
12264 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12265 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12266 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12267 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12268 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12269 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12270 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12271 cookies" below for more details.
12272
12273 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12274 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12275 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12276 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12277 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12278 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12279 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12280 and cookies" below for more details.
12281
12282 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12283 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12284 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12285 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12286 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12287 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12288 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12289 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12290
12291
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122928.2.4. Custom log format
12293------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012294
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012295The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012296mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012297
12298HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12299Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12300separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12301prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12302
12303Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12304variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12305string formats ("Q").
12306
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012307If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012308as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012309less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12310the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12311
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012312Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012313In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012314in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012315
12316Flags are :
12317 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012318 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012319
12320 Example:
12321
12322 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12323 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12324
12325At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12326
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012327 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12328 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012329
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012330the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012331
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012332 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012333 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012334 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012335
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012336and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12337
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012338 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012339 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12340
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012341Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12342
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012343 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012344 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012345 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12346 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12347 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012348 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12349 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12350 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012351 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012352 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012353 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012354 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012355 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012356 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012357 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12358 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012359 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012360 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12361 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012362 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012363 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12364 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012365 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12366 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12367 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012368 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012369 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12370 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012371 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012372 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12373 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12374 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012375 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012376 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12377 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12378 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12379 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012380 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012381 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012382 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012383 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012384 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012385 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012386 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12387 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12388 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012389 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012390 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12391 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012392 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012393 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012394 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012395 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012396
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012397 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012398
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012399
124008.2.5. Error log format
12401-----------------------
12402
12403When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12404protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12405By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12406"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12407will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12408logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12409
12410The format looks like this :
12411
12412 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12413 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12414 Connection error during SSL handshake
12415
12416 Field Format Extract from the example above
12417 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12418 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12419 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12420 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12421 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12422
12423These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12424failures.
12425
12426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124278.3. Advanced logging options
12428-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012429
12430Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12431just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12432options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12433for more information about their usage.
12434
12435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12437------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012438
12439It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12440haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12441commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12442monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12443ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12444
12445 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12446 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12447 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12448 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12449
12450 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12451 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12452 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012453 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012454 such as other load-balancers.
12455
12456 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12457 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12458 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12459
12460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12462----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012463
12464The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12465what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12466or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12467"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12468just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12469log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12470after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12471is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12472with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12473with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12474
12475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12477------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012478
12479Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12480for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12481"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12482retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12483raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12484a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12485file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12486you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12487"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12488
12489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12491--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012492
12493Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12494multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12495them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12496"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12497logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12498error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12499and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12500too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12501useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12502alternative.
12503
12504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125058.4. Timing events
12506------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012507
12508Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12509reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12510the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12511frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12512mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12513
12514 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12515 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12516 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12517 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12518 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12519
12520 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12521 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12522 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12523 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12524 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12525
12526 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12527 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12528 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12529 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12530 connection never established.
12531
12532 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12533 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12534 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12535 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12536 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12537 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12538 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12539 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12540 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12541 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12542 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12543
12544 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12545 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12546 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12547 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012548 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012549
12550 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12551
12552 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12553 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12554 negative.
12555
12556These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12557protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12558that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012559due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012560close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12561session has been aborted on timeout.
12562
12563Most common cases :
12564
12565 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12566 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12567 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12568 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12569 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12570 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12571 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12572 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12573 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012574 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12575 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12576 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012577
12578 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12579 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12580 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12581 of ms on remote networks.
12582
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012583 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12584 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12585 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012586
12587 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12588 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12589 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12590 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12591 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12592 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12593 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12594 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12595 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12596 to the server until another one is released.
12597
12598Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12599
12600 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12601 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12602 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12603
12604 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12605 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12606 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12607
12608 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12609 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12610 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12611 flags.
12612
12613 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12614 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12615 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12616 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12617 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12618 the client connection was maintained open.
12619
12620 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012621 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012622 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12623 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12624
12625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126268.5. Session state at disconnection
12627-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012628
12629TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12630"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
126312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12632each of which has a special meaning :
12633
12634 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12635 session to terminate :
12636
12637 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12638
12639 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12640 server explicitly refused it.
12641
12642 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12643 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12644 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12645 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012646 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12647
12648 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12649 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012650
12651 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12652 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12653 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12654 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12655 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12656
12657 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12658 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12659 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12660 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12661 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12662
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012663 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12664 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12665
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012666 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12667 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12668 backup connections when going up.
12669
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012670 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12671
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012672 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12673 send or receive data.
12674
12675 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12676 send or receive data.
12677
12678 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12679 with nothing left in the buffers.
12680
12681 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12682
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012683 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012684 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12685
12686 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12687 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12688 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12689 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12690 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12691
12692 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12693 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12694
12695 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12696 server (HTTP only).
12697
12698 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12699
12700 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12701 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12702 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12703
12704 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12705 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12706 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12707
12708 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12709
12710 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12711 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12712
12713 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12714 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12715 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12716
12717 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12718 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012719 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12720 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012721
12722 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12723 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12724 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12725 another server.
12726
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012727 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012728 server.
12729
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012730 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12731 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12732 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12733 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12734
12735 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12736 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12737 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12738 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12739
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012740 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12741 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12742 "use-server" rule).
12743
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012744 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12745
12746 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12747 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12748
12749 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12750
12751 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12752 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12753 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12754
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012755 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12756 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012757 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012758 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12759 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12760
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012761 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12762
12763 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12764 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12765
12766 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12767
12768 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12769
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012770The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12771was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012772helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12773starvation, attacks, etc...
12774
12775The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12776alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12777easier finding and understanding.
12778
12779 Flags Reason
12780
12781 -- Normal termination.
12782
12783 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12784 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12785 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12786 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12787
12788 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12789 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12790 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12791 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12792 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12793 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012794
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012795 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12796 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012797 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012798
12799 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12800 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12801 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12802
12803 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12804 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12805 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12806 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12807 the server takes too long to respond.
12808
12809 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12810 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12811 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12812 long a time to respond.
12813
12814 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12815 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12816 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12817 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012818 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
12819 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012820
12821 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12822 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12823 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12824 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12825 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012826 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012827 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
12828 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
12829 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
12830 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
12831 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
12832 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
12833 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
12834 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
12835 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
12836 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
12837 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
12838 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012839
12840 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12841 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012842 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12843 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12844 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12845 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012846
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012847 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12848 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012850 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012851 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12852 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12853 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12854 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12855 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12856
12857 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12858 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12859 503 or 504 here.
12860
12861 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12862 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12863 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12864 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12865 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12866
12867 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12868 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012869 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012870 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12871 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12872
12873 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12874 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12875 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12876 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12877 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12878 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12879 between haproxy and the server.
12880
12881 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12882 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12883 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12884 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12885 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12886 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12887 solution is to fix the application.
12888
12889 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12890 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12891 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12892 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12893 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12894 external attacks.
12895
12896 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12897 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012898 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012899 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12900 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12901
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012902 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12903 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12904 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012905 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12906 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012907
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012908 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12909 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12910 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12911 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012912 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12913 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12914 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12915 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12916 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012917
12918 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12919 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12920 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12921 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12922
12923 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12924 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12925 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12926 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12927
12928 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12929 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12930 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12931 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12932
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012933The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12934persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12935important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12936re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12937
12938 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12939
12940 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12941 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12942 set on a GET request.
12943
12944 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12945 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012946 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012947 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12948
12949 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12950 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12951 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12952
12953 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12954 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12955 already got a cookie.
12956
12957 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12958 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12959 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12960 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12961 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12962
12963 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12964 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12965 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12966
12967 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12968 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12969 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12970
12971 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12972 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12973
12974 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12975 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12976 then advertised in the response.
12977
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129798.6. Non-printable characters
12980-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012981
12982In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12983consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12984converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12985prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12986being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12987escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12988is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12989'}' when logging headers.
12990
12991Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12992issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12993containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12994
12995Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12996the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12997performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12998
12999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13001---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013002
13003Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13004achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013005section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013006cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13007the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13008the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013009locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013010not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13011user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13012a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13013wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13014
13015 Examples :
13016 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13017 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13018
13019 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13020 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13021
13022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13024---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013025
13026Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13027proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13028the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13029server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13030
13031Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13032response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013033section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013034
13035It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013036time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13037appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013038are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13039and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13040follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13041request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13042in the logs.
13043
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013044As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13045frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13046an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013048 Example :
13049 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13050 listen proxy-out
13051 mode http
13052 option httplog
13053 option logasap
13054 log global
13055 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13056
13057 # log the name of the virtual server
13058 capture request header Host len 20
13059
13060 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13061 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13062
13063 # log the beginning of the referrer
13064 capture request header Referer len 20
13065
13066 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13067 capture response header Server len 20
13068
13069 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13070 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13071
13072 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13073 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13074
13075 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13076 capture response header Via len 20
13077
13078 # log the URL location during a redirection
13079 capture response header Location len 20
13080
13081 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13082 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13083 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13084 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13085 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13086
13087 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13088 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13089 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13090 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013091 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013092
13093 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13094 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13095 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13096 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13097 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013098 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013099
13100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131018.9. Examples of logs
13102---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013103
13104These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13105them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13106reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13107
13108 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13109 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13110 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13111
13112 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13113 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13114
13115 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13116 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13117 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13118
13119 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13120 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13121
13122 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13123 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13124 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13125
13126 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013127 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013128 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13129 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13130
13131 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13132 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13133 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13134
13135 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13136 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013137 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013138 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13139 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13140 to return the 502 and not the server.
13141
13142 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013143 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013144
13145 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13146 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13147 Nothing was sent to any server.
13148
13149 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13150 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13151
13152 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13153 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13154 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13155 send a 408 return code to the client.
13156
13157 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13158 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13159
13160 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13161 5 seconds ("c----").
13162
13163 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13164 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013165 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013166
13167 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013168 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013169 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13170 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13171 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13172 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13173 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013174
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131769. Statistics and monitoring
13177----------------------------
13178
13179It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13180mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13181CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13182Unix socket.
13183
13184
131859.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013186---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013187
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013188The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013189page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13190begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13191represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13192use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13193('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13194(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13195text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13196do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13197use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013198
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013199In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13200that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13201S (Servers).
13202
13203 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13204 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13205 any name for server/listener)
13206 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13207 number queued without a server assigned.
13208 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13209 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13210 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13211 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13212 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13213 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13214 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13215 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13216 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13217 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13218 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13219 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13220 "option checkcache".
13221 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13222 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13223 - read error from the client
13224 - client timeout
13225 - client closed connection
13226 - various bad requests from the client.
13227 - request was tarpitted.
13228 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13229 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13230 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13231 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13232 active servers).
13233 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13234 Some other errors are:
13235 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13236 - failure applying filters to the response.
13237 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13238 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13239 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13240 switched away from.
13241 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13242 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13243 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13244 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13245 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13246 the server is up.)
13247 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13248 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13249 counters for each server.
13250 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13251 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13252 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13253 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13254 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13255 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13256 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13257 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13258 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13259 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13260 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13261 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13262 of times that server was selected.
13263 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13264 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13265 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13266 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13267 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13268 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013269 UNK -> unknown
13270 INI -> initializing
13271 SOCKERR -> socket error
13272 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harveycac41222015-04-16 11:13:21 -080013273 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013274 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13275 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13276 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13277 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13278 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13279 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13280 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13281 disable-on-404
13282 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13283 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13284 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013285 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13286 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13287 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13288 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13289 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13290 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13291 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13292 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13293 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13294 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13295 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13296 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13297 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13298 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13299 (inc. in eresp)
13300 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13301 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13302 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13303 (CPU/BW limit)
13304 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13305 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13306 server/backend
13307 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13308 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13309 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13310 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13311 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13312 (0 for TCP)
13313 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13314 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013315
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133179.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013318-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013319
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013320The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13321necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13322A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13323issuing commands by hand :
13324
13325 global
13326 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13327 stats timeout 2m
13328
13329It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13330the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13331never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13332situations :
13333
13334 global
13335 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13336 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13337 stats timeout 2m
13338
13339To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13340swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13341to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13342syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13343
13344 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13345 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13346
13347The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13348script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13349for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13350
13351The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13352that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13353editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13354(eg: watch a counter).
13355
13356The socket supports two operation modes :
13357 - interactive
13358 - non-interactive
13359
13360The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13361this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13362sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13363mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13364commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13365example :
13366
13367 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13368
13369The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13370entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13371for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13372sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13373"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13374after processing the last command of the same line.
13375
13376For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13377"prompt" command :
13378
13379 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13380 prompt
13381 > show info
13382 ...
13383 >
13384
13385Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13386delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13387that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13388parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013389
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013390It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13391on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13392own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013393
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013394The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13395If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13396all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13397it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13398
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013399add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013400 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13401 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13402 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13403 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013404
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013405add map <map> <key> <value>
13406 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13407 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013408 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13409 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13410 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013411
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013412clear counters
13413 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13414 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13415 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13416 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13417 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13418
13419clear counters all
13420 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13421 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13422 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13423
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013424clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013425 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13426 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13427 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013428
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013429clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013430 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13431 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13432 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013433
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013434clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13435 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13436
13437 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13438 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13439 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13440 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13441 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13442 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13443
13444 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13445
13446 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13447 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13448 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13449 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13450 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13451 the ACLs :
13452
13453 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13454 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13455 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13456 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13457 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13458 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13459
13460 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013461 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13462 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013463
13464 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013465 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013466 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013467 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13468 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13469 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13470 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013471
13472 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13473
13474 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013475 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013476 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13477 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013478 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13479 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13480 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013481
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013482del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13483 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013484 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13485 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13486 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13487 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013488
13489del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013490 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013491 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13492 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13493 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13494 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013495
13496disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013497 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13498
13499 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13500 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13501 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13502 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13503 re-enabled using enable agent.
13504
13505 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13506 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13507 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13508 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13509 otherwise unchanged.
13510
13511 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13512 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13513 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13514
13515 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13516 level "admin".
13517
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013518disable frontend <frontend>
13519 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13520 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13521 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13522 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13523 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13524 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13525 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13526 on the stats page.
13527
13528 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13529 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13530
13531 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13532 level "admin".
13533
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013534disable health <backend>/<server>
13535 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13536 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13537 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13538 agent check forces it down.
13539
13540 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13541 level "admin".
13542
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013543disable server <backend>/<server>
13544 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13545 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13546 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13547 during the maintenance.
13548
13549 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13550 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13551
13552 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013553 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013554
13555 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13556 level "admin".
13557
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013558enable agent <backend>/<server>
13559 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13560
13561 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13562 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13563
13564 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13565 level "admin".
13566
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013567enable frontend <frontend>
13568 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13569 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13570 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13571 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13572 which was disabled.
13573
13574 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13575 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13576
13577 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13578 level "admin".
13579
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013580enable health <backend>/<server>
13581 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13582 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13583
13584 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13585 level "admin".
13586
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013587enable server <backend>/<server>
13588 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13589 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13590
13591 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013592 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013593
13594 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13595 level "admin".
13596
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013597get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013598get acl <acl> <value>
13599 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13600 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13601 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13602 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13603 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013604
13605 The first two words are:
13606
13607 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13608 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13609 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13610
13611 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13612
13613 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13614
13615 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13616
13617 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13618 interpretation of the case.
13619
13620 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13621 useful with regular expressions.
13622
13623 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13624 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13625
13626 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13627 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13628 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13629
13630 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13631
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013632get weight <backend>/<server>
13633 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13634 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13635 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13636 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13637 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013638 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013639
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013640help
13641 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13642 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013643
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013644prompt
13645 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13646 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13647 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13648 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13649 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13650 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13651 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13652 command.
13653
13654quit
13655 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013656
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013657set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013658 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13659 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13660 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013661
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013662set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013663 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13664 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13665 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13666 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13667 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013668 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13669 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13670
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013671set maxconn global <maxconn>
13672 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13673 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13674 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13675 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13676 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13677 setting.
13678
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013679set rate-limit connections global <value>
13680 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13681 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13682 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13683 is passed in number of connections per second.
13684
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013685set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13686 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13687 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013688 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13689 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013690
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013691set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13692 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13693 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13694 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13695 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13696
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013697set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13698 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13699 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13700 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13701 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13702 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13703
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013704set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13705 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13706 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13707 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13708
13709set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13710 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13711 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13712 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13713
13714set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13715 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13716 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13717 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13718 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13719 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13720 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13721 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13722 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13723
13724set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13725 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13726 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13727
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013728set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13729 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13730 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13731 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13732 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13733
13734 Example:
13735 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13736 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13737 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13738 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13739
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013740set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013741 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13742 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13743 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13744 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013745 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13746 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013747
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013748set timeout cli <delay>
13749 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13750 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13751 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13752
13753set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13754 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13755 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013756 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13757 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13758 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13759 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13760 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13761 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13762 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13763 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13764 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13765 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13766 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13767 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13768 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013769
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013770show errors [<iid>]
13771 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13772 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013773 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13774 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13775 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013776
13777 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13778 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13779 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13780 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13781 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13782 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13783 are reported too.
13784
13785 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13786 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13787 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13788 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13789 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13790 code.
13791
13792 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13793 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13794 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13795 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13796 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13797 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13798 line.
13799
13800 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013801 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13802 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013803 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13804 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13805
13806 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13807 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13808 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13809 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13810 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13811 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13812 00204+ minal\r\n
13813 00211 \r\n
13814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013815 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013816 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13817 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13818 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13819 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13820 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13821 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013822
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013823show info
13824 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13825
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013826show map [<map>]
13827 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013828 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13829 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13830 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13831 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13832 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13833 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013834
13835show acl [<acl>]
13836 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013837 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13838 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13839 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13840 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13841 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013842
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013843show pools
13844 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13845 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13846 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13847 the pools.
13848
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013849show sess
13850 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013851 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13852 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13853
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013854show sess <id>
13855 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13856 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13857 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13858 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13859 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013860 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13861 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13862
13863 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13864 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013865
13866show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13867 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13868 possible to dump only selected items :
13869 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13870 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13871 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13872 for example:
13873 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13874 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13875 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13876
13877 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013878 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13879 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013880 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13881 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13882 Nbproc: 1
13883 Process_num: 1
13884 (...)
13885
13886 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13887 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13888 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13889 (...)
13890 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13891
13892 $
13893
13894 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13895 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13896 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13897 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013898 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013899
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013900show table
13901 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13902 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13903 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13904 entries currently in use.
13905
13906 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013907 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013908 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13909 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013910
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013911show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013912 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13913 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13914 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013915 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13916
13917 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13918 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13919 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13920 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13921 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13922
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013923 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13924 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13925 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13926 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13927 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13928 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13929
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013930
13931 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013932 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13933 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013934
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013935 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013936 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013937 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013938 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13939 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13940 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13941 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013942
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013943 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013944 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013945 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13946 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013947
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013948 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13949 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013950 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013951 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13952 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013953
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013954 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13955 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013956 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013957 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13958 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13959
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013960 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13961 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13962 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13963 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13964 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13965
13966 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13967 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13968 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013969 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13970 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013971 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13972 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013973
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013974shutdown frontend <frontend>
13975 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13976 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13977 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13978 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13979 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13980 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13981 once it is terminated.
13982
13983 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13984 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13985
13986 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13987 level "admin".
13988
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013989shutdown session <id>
13990 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13991 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13992 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13993 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13994 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13995 flag in the logs.
13996
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013997shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013998 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13999 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14000 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14001 'K' flag in the logs.
14002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014003/*
14004 * Local variables:
14005 * fill-column: 79
14006 * End:
14007 */